Lexmark Scanner 496 User Manual

XM7100 Series  
User's Guide  
September 2012  
Machine type(s):  
7463  
Model(s):  
496, 696, 896  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety information  
8
Safety information  
Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily accessible.  
Do not place or use this product near water or wet locations.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or performance of  
procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
This product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat may cause the media to release emissions.  
You must understand the section in your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print media  
to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The lithium battery in this product is not intended to be replaced. There is a  
danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Do not recharge, disassemble, or incinerate a  
lithium battery. Discard used lithium batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions and local  
regulations.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
If an optional tray is installed, then remove it from the printer. To remove the optional tray, slide the latch on the  
right side of the tray toward the front of the tray until it clicks into place.  
Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it.  
Make sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.  
Before setting up the printer, make sure there is adequate clearance around it.  
Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.  
Use only the telecommunications (RJ11) cord provided with this product or a 26 AWG or larger replacement when  
connecting this product to the public switched telephone network.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Make sure that all external connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system  
connections) are properly installed in their marked plug-in ports.  
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific  
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer is not  
responsible for the use of other replacement parts.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not cut, twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power cord. Do not  
subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects such as furniture  
and walls. If any of these things happen, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect the power cord regularly  
for signs of such problems. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet before inspecting it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Safety information  
9
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a service representative.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer,  
unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before proceeding.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
10  
Learning about the printer  
Finding information about the printer  
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
Initial setup instructions:  
Setup documentation—The setup documentation came  
with the printer and is also available at  
Connecting the printer  
Installing the printer software  
Additional setup and instructions for using the printer:  
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media  
Loading paper  
User's Guide and Quick Reference Guide—The guides are  
available on the Documentation CD.  
For more information, visit  
Configuring printer settings  
Viewing and printing documents and photos  
Setting up and using the printer software  
Configuring the printer on a network  
Caring for and maintaining the printer  
Troubleshooting and solving problems  
Instructions for:  
NetworkingGuide—OpentheSoftwareCD, and thenlook  
for Printer and Software Documentation under the Pubs  
folder. From the list of publications, click the Networking  
Guide link.  
Connecting the printer to an Ethernet network  
Troubleshooting printer connection problems  
Help using the printer software  
WindowsorMac Help—Openaprintersoftware program  
or application, and then click Help.  
?
Click  
to view contextsensitive information.  
Notes:  
Help is automatically installed with the printer  
software.  
The printer software is located in the printer  
program folder or on the desktop, depending on  
your operating system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Learning about the printer  
11  
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
The latest supplemental information, updates, and customer  
support:  
Lexmark Support Web site—  
Documentation  
Driver downloads  
Live chat support  
Email support  
Voice support  
Note: Select your country or region, and then select  
your product to view the appropriate support site.  
Support telephone numbers and hours of operation for  
your country or region can be found on the Support Web  
site or on the printed warranty that came with your  
printer.  
Record the following information (located on the store  
receipt and at the back of the printer), and have it ready  
when you contact customer support so that they may  
serve you faster:  
Machine Type number  
Serial number  
Date purchased  
Store where purchased  
Warranty information  
Warranty information varies by country or region:  
In the U.S.—See the Statement of Limited Warranty  
included with this printer, or at  
In other countries and regions—See the printed  
warranty that came with your printer.  
Selecting a location for the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
When selecting a location for the printer, leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors. If you plan to install any  
options, then leave enough room for them also. It is important to:  
Set up the printer near a properly grounded and easily accessible electrical outlet.  
Make sure airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard or the CEN Technical Committee  
156 standard.  
Provide a flat, sturdy, and stable surface.  
Keep the printer:  
Clean, dry, and free of dust.  
Away from stray staples and paper clips.  
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators.  
Free from direct sunlight and humidity extremes.  
Observe the recommended temperatures and avoid fluctuations:  
Ambient temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)  
Storage temperature 1 to 35°C (34 to 95°F)  
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
12  
5
4
1
3
2
1
2
3
4
5
Right side 15 cm (6 in.)  
Front 39.4 cm (15.5 in.)  
Left side 15 cm (6 in.)  
Rear  
Top  
15 cm (6 in.)  
15 cm (6 in.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Learning about the printer  
13  
Printer configurations  
Basic model  
1
2
3
9
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
ADF tray  
ADF bin  
Standard bin  
Multipurpose feeder  
Standard 550-sheet tray  
2100-sheet tray  
Caster base  
Printer control panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
14  
Configured model  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
5
1
2
4
3
Hardware option Alternative hardware option  
1
Staple finisher  
4bin mailbox  
Offset stacker  
Staple, hole punch finisher  
2
3
4
5
550sheet trays 2100sheet tray  
Caster base  
None  
2100sheet tray 550sheet trays  
4bin mailbox  
Staple finisher  
Staple, hole punch finisher  
Offset stacker  
When using optional trays:  
Always use a caster base when the printer is configured with a 2100sheet tray.  
The 2100sheet tray must always be at the bottom of a configuration.  
You cannot use an optional 550sheet tray if the 2100sheet tray is installed.  
A maximum of three optional trays may be configured with the printer.  
The printer supports only one finisher at a time.  
Understanding the basic functions of the scanner  
Make quick copies or set the printer to perform specific copy jobs.  
Send a fax using the printer control panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
15  
Send a fax to multiple fax destinations at the same time.  
Scan documents and send them to your computer, an e-mail address, a flash drive, or an FTP destination.  
Scan documents and send them to another printer (PDF through an FTP).  
Using the ADF and scanner glass  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
UsetheADFformultiplepagedocumentsincludingtwo- Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents, book pages,  
sided (duplex) pages. small items (such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo  
paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings).  
You can use the ADF or the scanner glass to scan documents.  
Using the ADF  
When using the ADF:  
Load the document into the ADF tray faceup, short edge first.  
Load up to 150 sheets of plain paper into the ADF tray.  
Scan sizes from 76.2 x 127 mm (3 x 5 inches) wide to 216 x 635 mm (8.5 x 25 inches) long  
Scan media weighs from 52 to 120 g/m2 (14–32 lb).  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings)  
into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Using the scanner glass  
When using the scanner glass:  
Place a document facedown on the scanner glass in the corner with the green arrow.  
Scan or copy documents up to 216 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Copy books up to 25.3 mm (1 inch) thick.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer control panel  
16  
Understanding the printer control panel  
Using the printer control panel  
1
2
3
@
!
.
2
5
8
0
A
B
C
3
D
E
F
1
G
H
I
J
K
U
L
M
N
X
O
4
6
4
5
P
Q
R
S
T
V
W
Y
Z
7
9
#
*
C
8
6
7
Use the  
1
To  
Display  
View the printer status and messages.  
Set up and operate the printer.  
2
3
Home button  
Sleep button  
Go to the home screen.  
Enable Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.  
Do the following to wake the printer from Sleep mode:  
Touch the screen or press any hard button.  
Open a door or cover.  
Send a print job from the computer.  
Perform a poweron reset (POR) with the main power switch.  
Attach a device to the USB port on the printer.  
4
5
6
7
8
Keypad  
Enter numbers, letters, or symbols.  
Start button  
Start a job, depending on which mode is selected.  
Clear all / Reset button Reset the default settings of a function, such as copying, faxing, or scanning.  
Stop or Cancel button Stop all printer activity.  
Indicator light  
Check the status of the printer.  
Understanding the colors of the Sleep button and indicator  
lights  
Thecolorsofthe Sleepbuttonandindicatorlightsonthe printercontrolpanelsignifya certainprinterstatusorcondition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer control panel  
17  
Indicator light color and its corresponding printer status  
Indicator light  
Off  
Printer status  
The printer is off or in Hibernate mode.  
The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.  
The printer is on, but idle.  
Blinking green  
Solid green  
Blinking red  
The printer requires user intervention.  
Sleep button light color and its corresponding printer status  
Sleep button light  
Off  
Printer status  
The printer is off, idle or in Ready state.  
The printer is in Sleep mode.  
Solid amber  
Blinking amber  
The printer is entering or waking from Hibernate mode.  
The printer is in Hibernate mode.  
Blinking amber for 0.1 second, then goes  
completely off for 1.9 seconds in a slow,  
pulsing pattern  
Understanding the home screen  
When the printer is turned on, the display shows a basic screen, referred to as the home screen. Touch the home screen  
buttons and icons to initiate an action such as copying, faxing, or scanning; to open the menu screen; or to respond to  
messages.  
Note: Your home screen may vary depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative setup, and  
active embedded solutions.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
14  
13  
7
8
12 11  
10  
9
Touch  
1
To  
Change Language  
Launch the Change Language popup window that lets you change the primary language of  
the printer.  
2
3
4
Copy  
Fax  
Access the Copy menus and make copies.  
Access the Fax menus and send fax.  
E-mail  
Access the E-mail menus and send emails.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer control panel  
18  
Touch  
To  
5
6
7
8
FTP  
Access the File Transfer Protocol (FTP) menus and scan documents directly to an FTP server.  
Scroll up or down.  
Arrows  
Forms and Favorites Quickly find and print frequently used online forms.  
Menu icon  
Access the printer menus.  
Note: The menus are available only when the printer is in Ready state.  
9
Bookmarks  
Create, organize, and save a set of bookmarks (URL) into a tree view of folders and file links.  
Note: The tree view supports only bookmarks created from this function, and not from any  
other application.  
10 USB Drive  
View, select, print, scan, or email photos and documents from a flash drive.  
Note: This icon appears only when you return to the home screen while a memory card or  
flash drive is connected to the printer.  
11 Held Jobs  
Display all current held jobs.  
12 Status/Supplies  
Show a warning or error message whenever the printer requires intervention to continue  
processing.  
Access the messages screen for more information on the message, and how to clear it.  
13 Tips  
Open a context-sensitive Help dialog.  
14 Search Held Jobs  
Search for one or more of the following items:  
User name for held or confidential print jobs  
Job names for held jobs, excluding confidential print jobs  
Profile names  
Bookmark container or print job names  
USB container or print job names for supported file types  
Features  
Feature  
Description  
Menu trail line  
Example:  
A menu trail line is located at the top of each menu screen. This feature shows the  
path taken to arrive at the current menu.  
Touch any of the underlined words to return to that menu.  
Menus > Settings > Copy Settings >  
Number of Copies  
Number of Copies is not underlined because it is the current screen. If you touch an  
underlined word on the “Number of Copies” screen before the number of copies is  
set and saved, then the selection is not saved, and it does not become the default  
setting.  
Attendance message alert  
If an attendance message affects a function, then this icon appears and the red  
indicator light blinks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer control panel  
19  
Feature  
Description  
Warning  
If an error condition occurs, then this icon appears.  
Status message bar  
Show the current printer status such as Readyor Busy.  
Show printer conditions such as Toner Lowor Cartridge Low.  
Show intervention messages so the printer can continue processing.  
Printer IP address  
Example:  
The IP address of your network printer is located at the upper left corner of the  
home screen and appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods. You can  
use the IP address when accessing the Embedded Web Server so you can view and  
remotely configure printer settings even when you are not physically near the  
printer.  
123.123.123.123  
Using the touch-screen buttons  
Note: Your home screen, icons, and buttons may vary, depending on your home screen customization settings,  
administrative setup, and active embedded solutions.  
1
7
6
3
2
5
4
Touch  
Arrows  
Copy It  
To  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
View a list of options.  
Print a copy.  
Advanced Options Select a copy option.  
Home  
Go to the home screen.  
Select a higher value.  
Select a lower value.  
Increase  
Decrease  
Tips  
Open a context-sensitive Help dialog.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer control panel  
20  
Other touch-screen buttons  
Touch  
To  
Accept  
Save a setting.  
Cancel  
Reset  
Cancel an action or a selection.  
Exit a screen and return to the previous screen without saving changes.  
Reset values on the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
21  
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
Notes:  
Your home screen may vary, depending on your home screen customization settings, administrative setup, and  
active applications.  
There may be additional solutions and applications available for purchase. For more information, visit  
www.lexmark.com or inquire at your point of purchase.  
Finding the IP address of the printer  
Note: Make sure your printer is connected to a network or to a print server.  
You can find the printer IP address:  
From the top left corner of the printer home screen.  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu.  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section.  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
Finding the IP address of the computer  
Note: Make sure that you know how your printer and computer are connected to the network (Ethernet or  
wireless).  
The computer IP address is required when setting up home screen applications, such as:  
Forms and Favorites  
Multi Send  
Scan to Network  
For Windows users  
1 Open the command window.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type cmd> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type cmd.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Type ipconfig, and then click Go or press Enter.  
Note: Type ipconfig /allto see additional useful information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
22  
3 Look for IP Address.  
The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
For Macintosh users  
Note: This is applicable only in Mac OS X version 10.5 or later.  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Network  
2 Click Ethernet, WiFi, or AirPort.  
3 Click Advanced > TCP/IP.  
4 Look for IPv4 Address.  
Accessing the Embedded Web Server  
The Embedded Web Server is the printer Web page that lets you view and remotely configure printer settings even  
when you are not physically near the printer.  
1 Obtain the printer IP address:  
From the printer control panel home screen  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
3 Press Enter.  
Note: If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
Customizing the home screen  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Do one or more of the following:  
Show or hide the icons of basic printer functions.  
a Click Settings > General Settings > Home screen customization.  
b Select the check boxes to specify which icons appear on the home screen.  
Note: If you clear a check box beside an icon, then the icon does not appear on the home screen.  
c Click Submit.  
Customize the icon for an application. For more information, see “Finding information about the home screen  
applications” on page 23 or see the documentation that came with the application.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
23  
Understanding the different applications  
Use  
To  
Card Copy  
Scan and print both sides of a card on a single page. For more information, see “Setting up Card Copy”  
Fax  
Scan a document, and then send it to a fax number. For more information, see “Faxing” on page  
Forms and Favorites Quickly find and print frequently used online forms directly from the printer home screen. For more  
Multi Send  
Scan a document, and then send it to multiple destinations. For more information, see “Setting up  
MyShortcut  
Create shortcuts directly on the printer home screen. For more information, see “Using MyShortcut”  
Scan to Email  
Scan to Computer  
Scan to FTP  
Scan a document, and then send it to an email address. For more information, see “E-mailing” on  
Scan a document, and then save it to a predefined folder on a host computer. For more information,  
Scan documents directly to a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) server. For more information, see “Scanning  
Scan to Network  
Scan a document, and then send it to a network shared folder. For more information, see “Setting  
Activating the home screen applications  
Finding information about the home screen applications  
Your printer comes with preinstalled home screen applications. Before you can use these applications, you must first  
activate and set up these applications using the Embedded Web Server. For more information on accessing the  
For more information on configuring and using the home screen applications, do the following:  
1 Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then do either of the following:  
Click Business Solutions, and then select the name of the application.  
Click Software and Solutions, and then select either of the following:  
Scan to Network—Find information about the Scan to Network application.  
Other Applications—Find information about the other applications.  
2 Click the Manuals tab, and then select the document for the home screen application.  
Setting up Forms and Favorites  
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator’s Guide of this application. To  
check for updates of this User’s Guide, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
24  
Use  
To  
Streamline work processes by letting you quickly find and print frequently used online forms directly  
from the printer home screen.  
Note: The printer must have permission to access the network folder, FTP site, or Web site where the  
bookmark is stored. From the computer where the bookmark is stored, use sharing, security, and  
firewall settings to allow the printer at least a read access. For help, see the documentation that  
came with your operating system.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Forms and Favorites.  
3 Click Add, and then customize the settings.  
Notes:  
See the mouse-over help beside each field for a description of the setting.  
To make sure the location settings of the bookmark are correct, type the correct IP address of the host  
computer where the bookmark is located. For more information on obtaining the IP address of the host  
Make sure the printer has access rights to the folder where the bookmark is located.  
4 Click Apply.  
To use the application, touch Forms and Favorites on the printer home screen, and then navigate through form  
categories, or search for forms based on a form number, name, or description.  
Setting up Card Copy  
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator's Guide of this application. To  
check for updates of this User's Guide, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Use  
To  
Quickly and easily copy insurance, identification, and other walletsize cards.  
You can scan and print both sides of a card on a single page, saving paper and showing the information  
on the card in a more convenient manner.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Card Copy.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
25  
3 Change the default scanning options, if necessary.  
Default tray—Select the default tray to be used for printing scan images.  
Default number of copies—Specify the number of copies that should automatically print when the application  
is used.  
Default contrast setting—Specify a setting to increase or decrease the level of contrast when a copy of the  
scanned card is printed. Select Best for Content if you want the printer to adjust the contrast automatically.  
Default scale setting—Set the size of the scanned card when printed. The default setting is 100% (full size).  
Resolution setting—Adjust the quality of the scanned card.  
Notes:  
When scanning a card, make sure the scan resolution is not more than 200 dpi for color, and 400 dpi for  
black and white.  
When scanning multiple cards, make sure the scan resolution is not more than 150 dpi for color, and  
300 dpi for black and white.  
Print Borders—Select the check box to print the scan image with a border around it.  
4 Click Apply.  
To use the application, touch Card Copy on the printer home screen, and then follow the instructions.  
Using MyShortcut  
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator's Guide of this application. To  
check for updates of this User's Guide, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Use  
To  
Create shortcuts on the printer home screen, with settings for up to 25 frequently used copy, fax, or e-  
mail jobs.  
To use the application, touch MyShortcut, and then follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Setting up Multi Send  
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator's Guide of this application. To  
check for updates of this User's Guide, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Use  
To  
Scan a document, and then send the scanned document to multiple destinations.  
Note: Make sure there is enough space in the printer hard disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
26  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The printer IP address appears as four sets of  
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Multi Send.  
3 From the Profiles section, click Add, and then customize the settings.  
Notes:  
See the mouseover help beside each field for a description of the setting.  
If you select FTP or Share Folder as a destination, then make sure the location settings of the destination are  
correct. Type the correct IP address of the host computer where the specified destination is located. For  
more information on obtaining the IP address of the host computer, see “Finding the IP address of the  
4 Click Apply.  
To use the application, touch Multi Send on the printer home screen, and then follow the instructions on the printer  
display.  
Setting up Scan to Network  
Note: A later version of this User's Guide may contain a direct link to the Administrator’s Guide of this application. To  
check for updates of this User's Guide, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Use  
To  
Scan a document and send it to a shared network folder. You can define up to 30 unique folder  
destinations.  
Notes:  
The printer must have permission to write to the destinations. From the computer where the  
destination is specified, use sharing, security, and firewall settings to allow the printer at least a  
write access. For help, see the documentation that came with your operating system.  
The Scan to Network icon appears only when one or more destinations are defined.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > Scan to Network.  
3 Specify the destinations, and then customize the settings.  
Notes:  
See the mouse-over help beside some of the fields for a description of the setting.  
To make sure the location settings of the destination are correct, type the correct IP address of the host  
computer where the specified destination is located. For more information on obtaining the IP address of  
Make sure the printer has access rights to the folder where the specified destination is located.  
4 Click Apply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
27  
To use the application, touch Scan to Network on the printer home screen, and then follow the instructions on the  
printer display.  
Setting up Remote Operator Panel  
This application shows the printer control panel on your computer screen and lets you interact with the printer control  
panel, even when you are not physically near the network printer. From your computer screen, you can view the printer  
status, release held print jobs, create bookmarks, and do other print-related tasks you might normally do while standing  
at the network printer.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 Click Settings > Remote Operator Panel Settings.  
3 Select the Enabled check box, and then customize the settings.  
4 Click Submit.  
To use the application, click Remote Operator Panel > Launch VNC Applet.  
Exporting and importing a configuration  
You can export configuration settings into a text file, and then import the file to apply the settings to other printers.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Note: View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
2 To export or import a configuration for one application, do the following:  
a Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management.  
b From the list of installed applications, click the name of the application you want to configure.  
c Click Configure, and then do either of the following:  
To export a configuration to a file, click Export, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen to  
save the configuration file.  
Notes:  
When saving the configuration file, you can type a unique file name or use the default name.  
If a "JVM Out of Memory” error occurs, then repeat the export process until the configuration file is  
saved.  
To import a configuration from a file, click Import, and then browse to the saved configuration file that was  
exported from a previously configured printer.  
Notes:  
Before importing the configuration file, you can choose to preview it first or load it directly.  
If a timeout occurs and a blank screen appears, then refresh the Web browser, and then click Apply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setting up and using the home screen applications  
28  
3 To export or import a configuration for multiple applications, do the following:  
a Click Settings > Import/Export.  
b Do either of the following:  
To exportaconfiguration file, click Export Embedded Solutions Settings File, and then follow the instructions  
on the computer screen to save the configuration file.  
To import a configuration file, do the following:  
1 Click Import EmbeddedSolutionsSettingsFile> ChooseFile, and thenbrowse tothe savedconfiguration  
file that was exported from a previously configured printer.  
2 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
29  
Additional printer setup  
Installing internal options  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or connectors.  
Available internal options  
Memory card  
DDR3 DIMM  
Flash memory  
Fonts  
Firmware cards  
Forms barcode  
PRESCRIBE  
IPDS  
Printcryption  
LexmarkTM Internal Solutions Ports (ISP)  
Parallel 1284-B interface  
MarkNetTM N8350 802.11 b/g/n wireless printer server  
MarkNet N8130 10/100 fiber interface  
RS-232-C serial interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
30  
Accessing the controller board  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
1 Open the controller board access cover.  
2 Using a screwdriver, loosen the screws on the controller board shield.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
31  
3 Remove the shield.  
1
2
4 Use the following illustration to locate the appropriate connector.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or  
connectors.  
1
2
3
1
2
3
Lexmark Internal Solutions Port or printer hard disk connector  
Option card connector  
Memory card connector  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
32  
5 Reattach the shield, and then align the screws with the holes.  
2
1
6 Tighten the screws on the shield.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
33  
7 Close the access cover.  
Installing a memory card  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch something metal on the printer first before touching any controller board electronic components or  
connectors.  
An optional memory card can be purchased separately and attached to the controller board.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 Unpack the memory card.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the connection points along the edge of the card. Doing so may  
cause damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
34  
3 Align the notch (1) on the memory card with the ridge (2) on the connector.  
1
2
4 Push the memory card straight into the connector, and then push the card toward the controller board wall until  
it clicks into place.  
5 Reattach the controller board shield, and then the controller board access cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
35  
Installing an optional card  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have other devices attached to the printer, then turn them  
off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 Unpack the optional card.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.  
3 Holding the card by its sides, align the plastic pins (1) on the card with the holes (2) on the controller board.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
36  
4 Push the card firmly into place as shown in the illustration.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Improper installation of the card may cause damage to the card and the  
controller board.  
Note: The entire length of the connector on the card must touch and be flushed against the controller board.  
5 Close the controller board access door.  
Note: When the printer software and any hardware options are installed, it may be necessary to manually add  
the options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see “Updating  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
37  
Installing an Internal Solutions Port  
The controller board supports one optional Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP).  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer first before touching any controller board electronic components or  
connectors.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 If a printer hard disk is installed, then remove the printer hard disk first.  
For more information, see “Removing a printer hard disk” on page 47.  
3 Unpack the ISP kit.  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
ISP solution  
Screw for attaching the plastic bracket to the ISP  
Screws for attaching the ISP mounting bracket to the controller board shield  
Plastic bracket  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
38  
4 Remove the metal cover from the ISP opening.  
a Loosen the screw.  
b Lift the metal cover, and then pull it out completely.  
1
2
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
39  
5 Align the posts of the plastic bracket to the holes on the controller board cage, and then press the plastic bracket  
on the controller board cage until it clicks into place.  
Note: Make sure that the plastic bracket has latched completely, and that the plastic bracket is seated firmly on  
the cage.  
6 Install the ISP on the plastic bracket.  
Note: Hold the ISP at an angle over the plastic bracket so that any overhanging connectors will pass through the  
ISP opening in the cage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
40  
7 Lower the ISP toward the plastic bracket until the ISP is seated between the guides of the plastic bracket.  
8 Use the provided thumbscrew for the ISP to attach the plastic bracket to the ISP.  
Note: Turn the screw clockwise, enough to hold the ISP in place, but do not tighten it yet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
41  
9 Attach the two provided screws to secure the ISP mounting bracket to the controller board shield.  
10 Tighten the thumbscrew that is attached to the ISP.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not screw it on too tightly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
42  
11 Connect the ISP solution interface cable into the receptacle of the controller board.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are color-coded.  
Installing a printer hard disk  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 Unpack the printer hard disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
43  
3 Locate the appropriate connector on the controller board cage.  
Note: If an optional ISP is currently installed, then the printer hard disk must be installed onto the ISP.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
44  
To install a printer hard disk onto the ISP:  
a Remove the screws attached to the printer hard disk mounting bracket, and then remove the bracket.  
b Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk to the holes in the ISP, and then press the printer hard disk down  
until the standoffs are in place.  
Installation warning: Hold only the edges of the printed circuit board assembly. Do not touch or press on  
the center of the printer hard disk. Doing so may cause damage.  
c Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the ISP.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are colorcoded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
45  
To install a printer hard disk directly on the controller board cage:  
a Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk to the holes in the controller board cage, and then press the printer  
hard disk down until the standoffs are in place.  
Installation warning: Hold only the edges of the printed circuit board assembly. Do not touch or press on  
the center of the printer hard disk. Doing so may cause damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
46  
b Use the two provided screws to attach the printer hard disk mounting bracket.  
c Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the controller board.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are colorcoded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
47  
Removing a printer hard disk  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 Unplug the printer hard disk interface cable from the controller board, leaving the cable attached to the printer  
hard disk. To unplug the cable, squeeze the paddle at the plug of the interface cable to disengage the latch before  
pulling out the cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
48  
3 Remove the screws holding the printer hard disk in place.  
4 Remove the printer hard disk.  
5 Set aside the printer hard disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
49  
Installing hardware options  
Order of installation  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Install the printer and any options you have purchased in the following order:  
Caster base  
Optional 2100sheet tray or 550sheet trays  
Printer  
For more information on installing a caster base or finisher see the setup documentation that came with the option.  
Installing optional trays  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
1 Turn off the printer using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
50  
1
2
2 Unpack the optional tray, and then remove all packing material.  
3 Pull out the tray completely from the base.  
4 Remove any packing material from inside the tray.  
5 Insert the tray into the base.  
6 Place the tray near the printer.  
7 Align the optional tray with the caster base.  
Note: Make sure to lock the wheels of the caster base to secure the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
51  
8 Align the printer with the tray, and then slowly lower the printer into place.  
Note: Optional trays lock together when stacked.  
9 Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
52  
2
1
Note: When the printer software and any optional trays are installed, you may need to manually add the  
options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see “Updating  
To uninstall the optional trays, slide the latch on the right side of the printer toward the front of the printer until  
it clicks into place, and then remove stacked trays one at a time from the top to the bottom.  
Attaching cables  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product  
or make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a  
lightning storm.  
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable or to the network using an Ethernet cable.  
Make sure to match the following:  
The USB symbol on the cable with the USB symbol on the printer  
The appropriate Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
53  
7
6
1
2
5
4
3
Use the  
To  
1
2
EXT port  
Connect additional devices (telephone or answering machine) to the printer and  
the telephone line. Use this port if you do not have a dedicated fax line for the  
printer and if this connection method is supported in your country or region.  
Note: Remove the plug to access the port.  
LINE port  
Connect the printer to an active telephone line through a standard wall jack  
(RJ11), DSL filter, or VoIP adapter, or any other adapter that allows you to access  
the telephone line to send and receive faxes.  
3
4
5
6
Printer power cord socket  
USB printer port  
Connect the printer to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
Connect the printer to a computer.  
Ethernet port  
Connect the printer to a network.  
Internal Solutions Port (ISP) or  
printer hard disk slot  
Attach an ISP or a printer hard disk.  
Note: If the printer has support  
for wireless connection, then the  
wireless antenna is attached  
here.  
7
USB port  
Attach an optional wireless network adapter.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the USB cable, any wireless network adapter, or the printer in the area  
shown while actively printing. Loss of data or a malfunction can occur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
54  
Organizing cables  
Attach the Ethernet cable and power cord, and then neatly tuck the cables in the channels at the back of the printer.  
Setting up the printer software  
Installing the printer software  
Notes:  
If you installed the printer software on the computer before but need to reinstall the software, then uninstall  
the current software first.  
Close all open software programs before installing the printer software.  
For Macintosh users, you may download all the drivers and utilities from our Web site.  
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software CD that came with your printer  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
2 Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using the Software CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
55  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK.  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
3 Click Install, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Updating available options in the printer driver  
When any hardware options are installed, you may need to manually add the options in the printer driver to make  
them available for use.  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Depending on your device, do either of the following:  
Press and hold the printer you want to update.  
Rightclick the printer you want to update.  
3 From the menu that appears, do either of the following:  
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.  
For earlier versions, select Properties.  
4 Click the Configuration tab.  
5 Do either of the following:  
Click Update Now Ask Printer.  
Under Configuration Options, manually add any installed hardware options.  
6 Click Apply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
56  
For Macintosh users  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan > select your printer > Options & Supplies > Driver  
System Preferences > Print & Fax > select your printer > Options & Supplies > Driver  
2 Add any installed hardware options, and then click OK.  
Networking  
Notes:  
Purchase a MarkNet N8350 wireless network adapter first before setting up the printer on a wireless network.  
For information on installing the wireless network adapter, see the setup sheet that came with the adapter.  
A Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name assigned to a wireless network. Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP), Wi-Fi  
Protected Access (WPA), and WPA2 are types of security used on a network.  
Preparing to set up the printer on an Ethernet network  
To configure your printer to connect to an Ethernet network, organize the following information before you begin:  
Note: If your network automatically assigns IP addresses to computers and printers, continue on to installing the  
printer.  
A valid, unique IP address for the printer to use on the network  
The network gateway  
The network mask  
A nickname for the printer (optional)  
Note: A printer nickname can make it easier for you to identify your printer on the network. You can choose to  
use the default printer nickname, or assign a name that is easier for you to remember.  
You will need an Ethernet cable to connect the printer to the network and an available port where the printer can  
physically connect to the network. Use a new network cable when possible to avoid potential problems caused by a  
damaged cable.  
Installing the printer on an Ethernet network  
For Windows users  
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software CD that came with your printer  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
2 Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using the Software CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
57  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
3 Click Install, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
4 Select Ethernet connection, and then click Continue.  
5 Attach the Ethernet cable when instructed to do so.  
6 Select the printer from the list, and then click Continue.  
Note: If the configured printer does not appear in the list, then click Modify Search.  
7 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
For Macintosh users  
1 Allow the network DHCP server to assign an IP address to the printer.  
2 Obtain the printer IP address either:  
From the printer control panel  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section  
Note: You will need the IP address if you are configuring access for computers on a different subnet than the printer.  
3 Install the printer driver on the computer.  
a Download the driver at http://support.lexmark.com.  
b Doubleclick the installer package for the printer, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
c Select a destination, and then click Continue.  
d From the Easy Install screen, click Install.  
e Type the user password, and then click OK.  
All the necessary applications are installed on the computer.  
f Click Close when installation is complete.  
4 Add the printer.  
For IP printing:  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +.  
c Click the IP tab.  
d Type the printer IP address in the address field, and then click Add.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
58  
For AppleTalk printing:  
Notes:  
Make sure AppleTalk is activated on your printer.  
This feature is supported only in Mac OS X version 10.5.  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +, and then navigate to:  
AppleTalk > select your printer > Add  
Preparing to set up the printer on a wireless network  
Notes:  
Make sure your wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
Make sure your access point (wireless router) is turned on and is working properly.  
Make sure you have the following information before setting up the printer on a wireless network:  
SSID—The SSID is also referred to as the network name.  
Wireless Mode (or Network Mode)—The mode is either infrastructure or ad hoc.  
Channel (for ad hoc networks)—The channel defaults to automatic for infrastructure networks.  
Some ad hoc networks will also require the automatic setting. Check with your system support person if you are  
not sure which channel to select.  
Security Method—There are four basic options for Security Method:  
WEP key  
If your network uses more than one WEP key, then enter up to four in the provided spaces. Select the key  
currently in use on the network by selecting the default WEP transmit key.  
WPA or WPA2 preshared key or passphrase  
WPA includes encryption as an additional layer of security. The choices are AES or TKIP. Encryption must be set  
for the same type on the router and on the printer, or the printer will not be able to communicate on the  
network.  
802.1X–RADIUS  
If you are installing the printer on an 802.1X network, then you may need the following:  
Authentication type  
Inner authentication type  
802.1X user name and password  
Certificates  
No security  
If your wireless network does not use any type of security, then you will not have any security information.  
Note: We do not recommend using an unsecured wireless network.  
Notes:  
If you do not know the SSID of the network that your computer is connected to, then launch the wireless utility  
of the computer network adapter, and then look for the network name. If you cannot find the SSID or the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
59  
security information for your network, then see the documentation that came with the access point, or contact  
your system support person.  
To find the WPA/WPA2 preshared key or passphrase for the wireless network, see the documentation that  
came with the access point, see the Embedded Web Server associated with the access point, or consult your  
system support person.  
Connecting the printer using the Wireless Setup Wizard  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
A wireless network adapter is installed in the printer and is working properly. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
An Ethernet cable is disconnected from the printer.  
Active NIC is set to Auto. To set this to Auto, navigate to:  
> Network/Ports > Active NIC > Auto > Submit  
Note: Make sure to turn off the printer, then wait for at least five seconds, and then turn the printer back on.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > Wireless Connection Setup  
2 Select a wireless connection setup.  
Use  
To  
Search for networks  
Show available wireless connections.  
Note: This menu item shows all broadcast secured or unsecured SSIDs.  
Enter a network name Manually type the SSID.  
Note: Make sure to type the correct SSID.  
WiFi Protected Setup Connect the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup.  
3 Follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
The access point (wireless router) is WiFi Protected Setup (WPS) certified or WPScompatible. For more  
information, see the documentation that came with your access point.  
A wireless network adapter installed in your printer is attached and working properly. For more information, see  
the instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
Using the Push Button Configuration method  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > Wireless Connection Setup > WiFi Protected  
Setup > Start Push Button Method  
2 Follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
60  
Using the Personal Identification Number (PIN) method  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless > Wireless Connection Setup > WiFi Protected  
Setup > Start PIN Method  
2 Copy the eightdigit WPS PIN.  
3 Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address of your access point in the address field.  
Notes:  
The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
4 Access the WPS settings. For more information, see the documentation that came with your access point.  
5 Enter the eightdigit PIN, and then save the setting.  
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using the Embedded Web Server  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
Your printer is connected temporarily to an Ethernet network.  
A wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless.  
3 Modify the settings to match the settings of your access point (wireless router).  
Note: Make sure to enter the correct SSID, security method, preshared key or passphrase, network mode, and  
channel.  
4 Click Submit.  
5 Turn off the printer, and then disconnect the Ethernet cable. Then wait for at least five seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
6 To verify if your printer is connected to the network, print a network setup page. Then in the Network Card [x]  
section, see if the status is Connected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
61  
Changing port settings after installing a new network Internal Solutions Port  
When a new Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP) is installed in the printer, the printer configurations on computers  
that access the printer must be updated since the printer will be assigned a new IP address. All computers that access  
the printer must be updated with this new IP address.  
Notes:  
If the printer has a static IP address, then you do not need to make any changes to the computer configurations.  
If the computers are configured to use the network name, instead of an IP address, then you do not need to  
make any changes to your computer configurations.  
If you are adding a wireless ISP to a printer previously configured for an Ethernet connection, then make sure  
the printer is disconnected from the Ethernet network when you configure the printer to operate wirelessly. If  
the printer is connected to the Ethernet network, then the wireless configuration completes, but the wireless  
ISP is inactive. To activate the wireless ISP, disconnect the printer from the Ethernet network, turn off the  
printer, and then turn it back on.  
Only one network connection is active at a time. To switch between Ethernet and wireless connection types,  
turn off the printer, connect the cable (to switch to an Ethernet connection) or disconnect the cable (to switch  
to a wireless connection), and then turn the printer back on.  
For Windows users  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type Runand then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
, or click Start and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
3 To select the printer that has changed, do either of the following:  
Press and hold the printer, and then select Printer properties.  
Rightclick the printer, and then select Printer properties (Windows 7 or later) or Properties (earlier versions).  
Note: If there is more than one copy of the printer, then update all of them with the new IP address.  
4 Click the Ports tab.  
5 Select the port from the list, and then click Configure Port.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
62  
6 Type the new IP address in the “Printer Name or IP Address” field.  
7 Click OK > Close.  
For Macintosh users  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Add the printer.  
For IP printing:  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +.  
c Click the IP tab.  
d Type the printer IP address in the address field, and then click Add.  
For AppleTalk printing:  
Notes:  
Make sure AppleTalk is activated on your printer.  
This feature is supported only in Mac OS X version 10.5.  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +, and then navigate to:  
AppleTalk > select the printer > Add  
Setting up serial printing  
Use serial printing to print when the computer is far from the printer or to print at a reduced speed.  
After installing the serial or communication (COM) port, configure the printer and the computer. Make sure you have  
connected the serial cable to the COM port on your printer.  
1 Set the parameters in the printer.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to the menu for the port settings.  
b Locate the menu for the serial port settings, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.  
c Save the modified settings, and then print a menu settings page.  
2 Install the printer driver.  
a Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software CD that came with your printer  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
63  
b Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using the Software CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the following:  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
1 Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
2 In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
3 Press Enter or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
c Click Install.  
d Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
e Select Advanced, and then click Continue.  
f From the Configure Printer Connection dialog, select a port.  
g If the port is not in the list, then click Refresh or navigate to:  
Add port > select a port type > enter the necessary information > OK  
h Click Continue > Finish.  
3 Set the COM port parameters.  
After installing the printer driver, set the serial parameters in the COM port assigned to the printer driver.  
Note: Make sure the serial parameters in the COM port match the serial parameters you set in the printer.  
a Open Device Manager.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type devmgmt.msc> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
1 Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
2 In the Start Search or Run dialog, type devmgmt.msc.  
3 Press Enter or click OK.  
b Doubleclick Ports (COM & LPT) to expand the list of available ports.  
c Do either of the following:  
Press and hold the COM port where you attached the serial cable to your computer (example: COM1).  
Rightclick the COM port where you attached the serial cable to your computer (example: COM1).  
d Click Properties.  
e On the Port Settings tab, set the serial parameters to the same serial parameters set in the printer.  
Check the serial heading of the menu settings page for the printer settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
64  
f Click OK, and then close all the dialogs.  
g Print a test page to verify printer installation.  
Verifying printer setup  
When all hardware and software options are installed and the printer is turned on, verify that the printer is set up  
correctly by printing the following:  
Menu settings page—Use this page to verify that all printer options are installed correctly. A list of installed options  
appears toward the bottom of the page. If an option you installed is not listed, then it is not installed correctly.  
Remove the option, and then install it again.  
Network setup page—If your printer has Ethernet or wireless capability and is attached to a network, then print a  
network setup page to verify the network connection. This page also provides important information that aids  
network printing configuration.  
Printing a menu settings page  
From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Reports > Menu Settings Page  
Printing a network setup page  
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This page  
also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Reports > Network Setup Page  
2 Check the first section of the network setup page, and confirm that the status is Connected.  
Ifthe status isNot Connected, then the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be malfunctioning.  
Consult a system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup page.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Loading paper and specialty media  
65  
Loading paper and specialty media  
The selection and handling of paper and specialty media can affect how reliably documents print. For more information,  
Setting the paper size and type  
From the home screen navigate to:  
> Paper Menu > Paper Size/Type > select a tray > select the paper size or type >  
Configuring Universal paper settings  
The Universal Paper Size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the printer  
menus.  
Notes:  
The smallest supported Universal size is 76.2 x 76.2 mm (3 x 3 inches).  
The largest supported Universal size is 216 x 359.92 mm (8.5 x 14.17 inches).  
When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 inches) wide, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent  
damage to the fuser.  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Paper Menu > Universal Setup > Units of Measure > select a unit of measure  
2 Touch Portrait Width or Portrait Height.  
3 Select the width or height, and then touch Submit.  
Loading the 550sheet tray  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
1 Pull out the tray.  
Notes:  
When loading folio, legal, or oficiosize paper, lift the tray slightly and pull it out completely.  
Avoid removing trays while a job prints or while Busyappears on the display. Doing so may cause a jam.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Loading paper and specialty media  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
67  
2 Squeeze and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until it clicks into  
place.  
1
2
Note: Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
68  
LT  
A4  
R
/
/
LG  
A5  
L
EX  
EC  
JI  
S
B5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
69  
3 Unlock the length guide, and then squeeze and slide the guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being  
loaded.  
2
3
Notes:  
Lock the length guide for all paper sizes.  
Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
70  
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
5 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.  
Note: Make sure the paper or envelope is loaded properly.  
There are different ways for loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is installed or  
not.  
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher  
A B C  
ABC  
Onesided printing  
Onesided printing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
71  
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher  
A B C  
ABC  
Twosided printing  
Twosided printing  
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the long edge  
of the paper are on the right side of the tray.  
Onesided printing  
Twosided printing  
A B C  
A B C  
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
72  
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.  
If you are loading envelopes, then make sure that the flap side is facing up and the envelopes are on the left  
side of the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
73  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the tray can cause paper jams.  
6 For customor Universalsize paper, adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack, and then lock  
the length guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
74  
7 Insert the tray.  
8 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.  
Loading the 2100sheet tray  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
1 Pull out the tray.  
2 Adjust the width and length guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
75  
Loading A5size paper  
a Pull up and slide the width guide to the position for A5.  
2
1
L
G
L
C
F
O
IO  
L
O
F
R
T
L
L
G
L
A4  
A5  
C
F
O
IO  
L
O
F
R
T
L
4
A
5
A
LGL  
OF  
C
FO  
LIO  
L
T
R
A4  
5
A
b Squeeze and slide the length guide to the position for A5 until it clicks into place.  
2
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
76  
c Remove the A5 length guide from its holder.  
1
2
d Insert the A5 length guide into its designated slot.  
Note: Press the A5 length guide until it clicks into place.  
Loading A4, letter, legal, oficio, and foliosize paper  
a Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.  
2
1
L
G
L
C
F
O
IO  
L
LGL  
OFC  
FOLIO  
O
F
R
LT  
R
T
L
4
A
5
A
4
A
5
A
LGL  
OF  
C
FO  
LIO  
L
T
R
A4  
5
A
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
77  
b If the A5 length guide is still attached to the length guide, then remove it from its place. If the A5 length guide  
is not attached, then proceed to step d.  
c Put the A5 length guide in its holder.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
78  
d Squeeze the length guide and slide it to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded until it clicks  
into place.  
3 Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
4 Load the paper stack with the printable side facedown.  
Note: Make sure the paper is loaded properly.  
There are different ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is installed or  
not.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
79  
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher  
A B C  
ABC  
Onesided printing  
Onesided printing  
ABC  
A B C  
Twosided printing  
Twosided printing  
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the long edge  
of the paper are on the right side of the tray.  
Onesided printing  
Twosided printing  
A B C  
A B C  
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
80  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the tray can cause paper jams.  
5 Insert the tray.  
Note: Press the paper stack down while inserting the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
81  
6 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded.  
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.  
Loading the multipurpose feeder  
1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door.  
Note: Do not load or close the multipurpose feeder while a job is printing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
83  
2 Using the handle, pull the multipurpose feeder extender.  
Note: Guide the extender gently so that the multipurpose feeder is fully extended and open.  
3 Slide the width guide to the correct position for the size of the paper being loaded.  
Note: Use the paper size indicators on the bottom of tray to help position the guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
84  
4 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.  
Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
Hold transparencies by the edges, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.  
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level  
surface.  
5 Load the paper or specialty media.  
Note: Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop.  
Load only one size and type of paper or specialty media at a time.  
Make sure the paper fits loosely in the multipurpose feeder, lies flat and is not bent or wrinkled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
85  
There are different ways of loading letterhead depending on whether an optional staple finisher is installed or  
not.  
Without an optional staple finisher With an optional staple finisher  
Onesided printing  
Onesided printing  
A B C  
ABC  
Twosided printing  
Twosided printing  
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the long edge  
of the paper are on the right side of the tray.  
Onesided printing  
Twosided printing  
A B C  
Note: If the holes on the long edge of the paper are on the left side of the tray, then a jam may occur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
86  
Load envelopes with the flap side down and on the left of the multipurpose feeder.  
R
L T  
5
A
4
A
C
E
X
E
5
B
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated linings, or  
selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
87  
Make sure the paper or specialty media is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Overfilling the feeder can cause paper jams.  
6 For custom- or universal-size paper, adjust the width guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack.  
7 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.  
Linking and unlinking trays  
When the paper size and paper type for any trays are the same, the printer will link those trays. When one linked tray  
becomes empty, paper will feed from the next linked tray. We recommend giving all unique paper, such as letterhead  
and different colored plain papers, a different custom type name so that the trays they are in will not automatically  
link.  
Linking and unlinking trays  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Loading paper and specialty media  
88  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu.  
3 Change the paper size and type settings for the trays you are linking.  
To link trays, make sure the paper size and type for the tray match that of the other tray.  
To unlink trays, make sure the paper size or type for the tray does not match that of the other tray.  
4 Click Submit.  
Note: You can also change the paper size and type settings using the printer control panel. For more information,  
Warning—Potential Damage: Paper loaded in the tray should match the paper type name assigned in the printer.  
The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified paper type. Printing issues may occur if settings are  
not properly configured.  
Creating a custom name for a paper type  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Names.  
3 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.  
4 Click Submit.  
5 Click Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Paper Menu > Custom Names  
2 Select a custom name, and then type a custom paper type name.  
3 Touch Submit.  
4 Touch Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
89  
Assigning a custom paper type  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
Assign a custom paper type name to a tray when linking or unlinking trays.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Types.  
3 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.  
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Paper Menu > Custom Types  
2 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.  
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.  
3 Touch Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guide  
90  
Paper and specialty media guide  
Notes:  
Make sure the paper size, type, and weight are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.  
Flex, fan, and straighten specialty media before loading it.  
The printer may print at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the fuser.  
For more information on card stock and labels, see the Card Stock & Label Guide on the Lexmark Web site at  
Using specialty media  
Tips on using card stock  
Card stock is heavy, singleply specialty media. Many of its variable characteristics, such as moisture content, thickness,  
and texture, can significantly affect print quality.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the card  
stock loaded in the tray.  
Print samples on the card stock being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Specify the paper texture and weight from the tray settings to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Preprinting, perforation, and creasing may significantly affect the print quality and cause jams or other paper feed  
problems.  
Before loading the card stock on the tray, flex and fan the card stock to loosen them. Straighten the edges on a  
level surface.  
Tips on using envelopes  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the  
envelopes loaded in the tray.  
Print samples on the envelopes being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Use envelopes designed specifically for laser printers.  
For best performance, use envelopes made from 90g/m2 (24lb) paper or 25% cotton.  
Use only new envelopes from undamaged packages.  
To optimize performance and minimize jams, do not use envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl or twist.  
Are stuck together or damaged in any way.  
Have windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing.  
Have metal clasps, string ties, or folding bars.  
Have an interlocking design.  
Have postage stamps attached.  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Paper and specialty media guide  
91  
Have bent corners.  
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes.  
Adjust the width guides to fit the width of the envelopes.  
Before loading the envelopes on the tray, flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and  
then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Note: A combination of high humidity (over 60%) and high printing temperature may wrinkle or seal envelopes.  
Tips on using labels  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the labels  
loaded in the tray.  
Print samples on labels being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
For more information on label printing, characteristics, and design, see the Card Stock & Label Guide at  
Use labels designed specifically for laser printers.  
Do not use labels with slick backing material.  
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing, resulting in a jam. Partial sheets  
also contaminate the printer and the cartridge with adhesive, and could void the printer and toner cartridge  
warranties.  
Do not use labels with exposed adhesive.  
Before loading labels on the tray, flex and fan labels to loosen them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Tips on using letterhead  
Use letterhead designed specifically for laser printers.  
Print samples on the letterhead being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Before loading letterhead, flex and fan the sheets to prevent them from sticking together.  
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead.  
Source  
Printing  
Printable side  
Paper orientation  
Trays  
Onesided  
Facedown  
Load the sheet with the  
top edge toward the front  
of the tray.  
Trays  
Twosided  
Onesided  
Twosided  
Faceup  
Load the sheet with the  
bottom edge entering the  
printer first.  
Multipurpose feeder  
Multipurpose feeder  
Faceup  
Load the sheet with the  
top edge entering the  
printer first.  
Facedown  
Load the sheet with the  
bottom edge entering the  
printer first.  
Note: Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine whether the preprinted letterhead is acceptable for laser  
printers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper and specialty media guide  
92  
Tips on using transparencies  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size, type, texture, and weight in the Paper menu to match the  
transparencies loaded in the tray.  
Print a test page on the transparencies being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers.  
Avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies to prevent print quality problems.  
Before loading transparencies, flex and fan the sheets to prevent them from sticking together.  
When printing on large volumes of transparencies, make sure to print by batches of only up to 20 with an interval  
of at least three minutes between batches, to prevent the transparencies from sticking together in the bin. You can  
also remove transparencies from the bin by batches of 20.  
Paper guidelines  
Paper characteristics  
The following paper characteristics affect print quality and reliability. Consider these factors before printing on them:  
Weight  
The printer trays and multipurpose feeder can automatically feed paper weights between 60–176 g/m2 (16–47lb) grain  
long paper. The 2100sheet tray can automatically feed paper weights up to 60–135 g/m2 (16–36lb) grain long paper.  
Paper lighter than 60 g/m2 (16 lb) might not be stiff enough to feed properly, and may cause jams.  
Note: Twosided printing is supported for 60–176 g/m2 (16–47lb) paper.  
Curl  
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can occur after  
the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper unwrapped in hot, humid,  
cold, or dry conditions, even in the trays, can contribute to paper curling prior to printing and can cause feeding  
problems.  
Smoothness  
Paper smoothness directly affects print quality. If paper is too rough, toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper is too  
smooth, it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. Always use paper between 100 and 300 Sheffield points;  
smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheffield points produces the best print quality.  
Moisture content  
The amount of moisture in paper affects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper correctly.  
Leave paper in its original wrapper until it is time to use it. This limits the exposure of paper to moisture changes that  
can degrade its performance.  
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing. Extend  
the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very different from the printer environment. Thick  
paper may also require a longer conditioning period.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guide  
93  
Grain direction  
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long, running the length of  
the paper, or grain short, running the width of the paper.  
For 60–176 g/m2 (16–47lb) paper, grain long paper is recommended.  
Fiber content  
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100% chemically treated pulped wood. This content provides the  
paperwith a high degree ofstability, resulting in fewer paper feeding problemsand better print quality. Paper containing  
fibers such as cotton can negatively affect paper handling.  
Selecting paper  
Using the appropriate paper prevents jams and helps ensure troublefree printing.  
To help avoid paper jams and poor print quality:  
Always use new, undamaged paper.  
Before loading paper, know the recommended printable side of the paper. This information is usually indicated on  
the paper package.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same tray; mixing results in jams.  
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.  
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead  
Use grain long for 60–90g/m2 (16–24lb) paper.  
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process.  
Avoid paper with rough or heavily textured surfaces.  
Use inks that are not affected by the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet these  
requirements; latex inks might not.  
Print samples on preprinted forms and letterheads considered for use before buying large quantities. This  
determines whether or not the ink in the preprinted form or letterhead will affect print quality.  
When in doubt, contact your paper supplier.  
Using recycled paper and other office papers  
As an environmentally conscientious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled paper produced specifically for  
use in laser (electrophotographic) printers.  
While no blanket statement can be made that all recycled paper will feed well, Lexmark consistently tests papers that  
represent recycled cut size copier papers available on the global market. This scientific testing is conducted with rigor  
and discipline. Many factors are taken into consideration both separately and as a whole, including the following:  
Amount of post-consumer waste (Lexmark tests up to 100% post-consumer waste content.)  
Temperature and humidity conditions (Testing chambers simulate climates from all over the world.)  
Moisture content (Business papers should have low moisture: 4–5%.)  
Bending resistance and proper stiffness means optimum feeding through the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guide  
94  
Thickness (impacts how much can be loaded into a tray)  
Surface roughness (measured in Sheffield units, impacts print clarity and how well toner fuses to the paper)  
Surface friction (determines how easily sheets can be separated)  
Grain and formation (impacts curling, which also influences the mechanics of how the paper behaves as it moves  
through the printer)  
Brightness and texture (look and feel)  
Recycled papers are better than ever; however, the amount of recycled content in a paper affects the degree of control  
over foreign matter. And while recycled papers are one goodpath to printing in an environmentally responsible manner,  
they are not perfect. The energy required to de-ink and deal with additives such as colorants and “glue” often generates  
more carbon emissions than does normal paper production. However, using recycled papers enables better resource  
management overall.  
Lexmark concerns itself with the responsible use of paper in general based on life cycle assessments of its products. To  
gain a better understanding of the impact of printers on the environment, the company commissioned a number of  
life cycle assessments and found that paper was identified as the primary contributor (up to 80%) of carbon emissions  
caused throughout the entire life of a device (from design to end-of-life). This is due to the energy-intensive  
manufacturing processes required to make paper.  
Thus, Lexmark seeks to educate customers and partners on minimizing the impact of paper. Using recycled paper is  
one way. Eliminating excessive and unnecessary paper consumption is another. Lexmark is well-equipped to help  
customers minimize printing and copying waste. In addition, the company encourages purchasing paper from suppliers  
who demonstrate their commitment to sustainable forestry practices.  
Lexmark does not endorse specific suppliers, although a converter’s product list for special applications is maintained.  
However, the following paper choice guidelines will help alleviate the environmental impact of printing:  
1 Minimize paper consumption.  
2 Be selective about the origin of wood fiber. Buy from suppliers who carry certifications such as the Forestry  
Stewardship Council (FSC) or The Program for the Endorsement of Forest Certification (PEFC). These certifications  
guarantee that the paper manufacturer uses wood pulp from forestry operators that employ environmentally and  
socially responsible forest management and restoration practices.  
3 Choose the most appropriate paper for printing needs: normal 75 or 80 g/m2 certified paper, lower weight paper,  
or recycled paper.  
Unacceptable paper examples  
Test results indicate that the following paper types are at risk for use with laser printers:  
Chemically treated papers used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless papers  
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer  
Preprinted papers that can be affected by the temperature in the printer fuser  
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise location on the page) greater than ± 2.3 mm (± 0.9 in.),  
such as optical character recognition (OCR) forms. In some cases, registration can be adjusted with a software  
application to successfully print on these forms.)  
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, thermal papers  
Rough-edged, rough or heavily textured surface papers or curled papers  
Recycled papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European testing)  
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m2 (16 lb)  
Multiple part forms or documents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guide  
95  
For more information about Lexmark, visit www.lexmark.com. General sustainability-related information can be found  
at the Environmental Sustainability link.  
Storing paper  
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:  
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40 percent. Most  
label manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18–24°C (65–75°F) with relative humidity  
between 40 and 60 percent.  
Store paper in cartons, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.  
Store individual packages on a flat surface.  
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.  
Take paper out of the carton or wrapper only when you are ready to load it in the printer. The carton and wrapper  
help keep the paper clean, dry, and flat.  
Supported paper sizes, types, and weights  
The following tables provide information on standard and optional paper sources and the types of paper they support.  
Note: For an unlisted paper size, select the closest larger listed size.  
Paper sizes supported by the printer  
Paper size1  
Dimensions  
550sheet tray 2100sheet tray Multipurpose Duplex  
ADF  
Scanner  
glass  
feeder  
A4  
210 x 297 mm  
(8.3 x 11.7 in.)  
A5  
148 x 210 mm  
(5.8 x 8.3 in.)  
2
X
A6  
105 x 148 mm  
(4.1 x 5.8 in.)  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
182 x 257 mm  
(7.2 x 10.1 in.)  
X
216 x 279 mm  
(8.5 x 11 in.)  
216 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
1 If your preferred default paper size cannot be set in the printer control panel, then you may select common paper sizes  
that correspond to the position of the length guide in the tray from the Paper Size/Type menu. If the paper size is not  
available, then select Universal or turn off tray size sensing. For more information, contact customer support.  
2 Paper is supported in longedge orientation.  
3 Universal is supported in duplex mode only if the width is from 105 mm (4.13 in.) to 216 mm (8.5 in.), and the length is  
from 148 mm (5.83 in.) to 356 mm (14 in.).  
4 When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 in.) wide, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the  
fuser.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guide  
96  
Paper size1  
Executive  
Dimensions  
550sheet tray 2100sheet tray Multipurpose Duplex  
ADF  
Scanner  
glass  
feeder  
184 x 267 mm  
(7.3 x 10.5 in.)  
X
Oficio (México) 216 x 340 mm  
(8.5 x 13.4 in.)  
Folio  
216 x 330 mm  
(8.5 x 13 in.)  
Statement  
Universal3,4  
140 x 216 mm  
(5.5 x 8.5 in.)  
X
X
105 x 216 mm to  
216 x 356 mm  
(4.13 x 8.5 in. to  
8.5 x 14 in.)  
7 3/4 Envelope 98 x 191 mm  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
(Monarch)  
(3.9 x 7.5 in.)  
9 Envelope  
98 x 225 mm  
(3.9 x 8.9 in.)  
X
X
X
X
X
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
105 x 241 mm  
(4.1 x 9.5 in.)  
110 x 220 mm  
(4.3 x 8.7 in.)  
162 x 229 mm  
(6.38 x 9.01 in.)  
176 x 250 mm  
(6.93 x 9.84 in.)  
Other Envelope 98 x 162 mm  
(3.9 x 6.4 in.) to  
X
X
X
176 x 250 mm  
(6.9 x 9.8 in.)  
1 If your preferred default paper size cannot be set in the printer control panel, then you may select common paper sizes  
that correspond to the position of the length guide in the tray from the Paper Size/Type menu. If the paper size is not  
available, then select Universal or turn off tray size sensing. For more information, contact customer support.  
2 Paper is supported in longedge orientation.  
3 Universal is supported in duplex mode only if the width is from 105 mm (4.13 in.) to 216 mm (8.5 in.), and the length is  
from 148 mm (5.83 in.) to 356 mm (14 in.).  
4 When printing on paper less than 210 mm (8.3 in.) wide, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the  
fuser.  
Paper types and weights supported by the printer  
The printer engine supports 60–176g/m2 (16–47lb) paper weights.  
Note: Labels, transparencies, envelopes, and card stock always print at reduced speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guide  
97  
Paper type  
550sheet tray 2100sheet  
tray  
Multipurpose  
feeder  
Duplex  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Paper  
Card Stock  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Plain Envelope  
Rough Envelope  
Paper Labels  
Pharmacy Labels  
Transparencies*  
X
X
X
X
* Print transparencies in batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information, see “Tips  
Paper sizes, types, and weights supported by the optional finishers  
Supported paper sizes  
Paper size  
4bin mailbox  
Offset stacker  
X
Staple finisher  
Staple, hole punch  
finisher  
A6  
X
1
X
1
A5  
JIS B5  
2
2
Executive  
Letter  
2
2
A4  
Legal  
3
Folio  
Oficio  
Statement  
Universal  
1
4
1
X
X
1 The finisher staples the paper if it is loaded long edge first.  
2 The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.  
3 The finisher stacks and staples the paper but does not punch holes in it.  
4 The finisher staples the paper if its width is from 210 mm (8.27 in.) to 217 mm (8.54 in.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guide  
98  
Supported paper types and weights  
Paper type  
Paper weight  
4bin mailbox  
Offset stacker  
X
Staple finisher  
X
Staple, hole punch  
finisher  
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
Plain paper  
X
X
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
163 g/m2  
(90 Ib)  
Card stock  
1
1
X
X
X
X
199 g/m2  
(110 Ib)  
X
X
X
X
Transparency2  
Recycled  
146 g/m2  
(39 Ib)  
1
1
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
X
X
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
180 g/m2  
(48 Ib)  
Paper labels  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
180 g/m2  
(48 Ib)  
Dual web and  
Integrated  
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
Bond  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
105 g/m2  
(28 Ib)  
Envelope  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
Letterhead  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
Preprinted  
X
X
X
X
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
1 The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.  
2 Print transparencies in batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information, see “Tips  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guide  
99  
Paper type  
Paper weight  
4bin mailbox  
Offset stacker  
X
Staple finisher  
X
Staple, hole punch  
finisher  
90–176 g/m2  
(24–47 lb)  
Colored paper  
X
X
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
Light paper  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
Heavy paper  
Rough/cotton  
Custom type [x]  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
60–90 g/m2  
(16–24 lb)  
1 The finisher stacks the paper but does not staple or punch holes in it.  
2 Print transparencies in batches of only up to 20 to prevent them from sticking together. For more information, see “Tips  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing  
100  
Printing  
Printing forms and a document  
Printing forms  
Use the Forms and Favorites application to quickly and easily access frequently used forms or other information that  
is regularly printed. Before you can use this application, first set it up on the printer. For more information, see “Setting  
1 From the printer home screen, navigate to:  
Forms and Favorites > select the form from the list > enter the number of copies > adjust other settings  
2 Depending on your printer model, touch  
,
, or Submit.  
Printing a document  
1 From the printer control panel, set the paper type and size to match the paper loaded.  
2 Send the print job:  
For Windows users  
a With a document open, click File > Print.  
b Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
c Adjust the settings, if necessary.  
d Click OK > Print.  
For Macintosh users  
a Customize the settings in the Page Setup dialog:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Page Setup.  
2 Choose a paper size or create a custom size to match the paper loaded.  
3 Click OK.  
b Customize the settings in the Print dialog:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the print options popup menus, adjust the settings, if necessary.  
Note: To print on a specific paper type, adjust the paper type setting to match the paper loaded, or  
select the appropriate tray or feeder.  
3 Click Print.  
Adjusting toner darkness  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing  
101  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness.  
3 Adjust the toner darkness, and then click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness  
2 Adjust the setting, and then touch Submit.  
Printing from a mobile device  
For the list of supported mobile devices and to download a compatible mobile printing application, visit  
Note: Mobile printing applications may also be available from your mobile device manufacturer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing  
102  
Printing from a flash drive  
Printing from a flash drive  
Notes:  
Before printing an encrypted PDF file, you will be prompted to type the file password from the printer control  
panel.  
You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions.  
1 Insert a flash drive into the USB port.  
1
@
5
!
.
2
A
B
C
4
G
H
I
3
D
E
F
J
K
L
7
P
Q
R
S
6
M
N
O
8
T
U
V
*
9
W
X
Y
Z
0
#
C
Notes:  
A flash drive icon appears on the printer home screen when a flash drive is inserted.  
If you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention, such as when a jam has occurred, then the  
printer ignores the flash drive.  
If you insert the flash drive while the printer is processing other print jobs, then Busyappears on the printer  
display. After these print jobs are processed, you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents  
from the flash drive.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the USB cable, any wireless network adapter, any connector, the  
memory device, or the printer in the areas shown while actively printing, reading, or writing from the memory  
device. Loss of data can occur.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
103  
1
@
5
!
.
2
A
B
C
4
G
H
I
3
D
E
F
J
K
L
7
P
Q
R
S
6
M
N
O
8
T
U
V
*
9
W
X
Y
Z
0
#
C
2 From the printer control panel, touch the document you want to print.  
3 Touch the arrows to get a preview of the document.  
4 Use  
Notes:  
Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing.  
or  
to specify the number of copies to be printed, and then touch Print.  
If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen, then touch Held Jobs on  
the home screen to print files from the flash drive.  
Supported flash drives and file types  
Notes:  
Highspeed USB flash drives must support the fullspeed standard. Low-speed USB devices are not supported.  
USB flash drives must support the File Allocation Table (FAT) system. Devices formatted with New Technology  
File System (NTFS) or any other file system are not supported.  
Recommended flash drives  
File type  
Documents:  
.pdf  
.xps  
Lexar JumpDrive FireFly (512MB and 1GB)  
SanDisk Cruzer Micro (512MB and 1GB)  
Sony Micro Vault Classic (512MB and 1GB)  
Images:  
.dcx  
.gif  
.jpeg or .jpg  
.bmp  
.pcx  
.tiff or .tif  
.png  
.fls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing  
104  
Printing confidential and other held jobs  
Storing print jobs in the printer  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Security > Confidential Print > select the print job type  
Use  
To  
Max Invalid PIN  
Limit the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.  
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and PIN  
are deleted.  
Confidential Job Expiration  
Hold print jobs in the computer until you enter the PIN from the printer control  
panel.  
Note: The PIN is set from the computer. It must be four digits, using the  
numbers 1–9.  
Repeat Job Expiration  
Verify Job Expiration  
Print and store print jobs in the printer memory.  
Print one copy of a print job and hold the remaining copies. It allows you to  
examine if the first copy is satisfactory. The print job is automatically deleted  
from the printer memory when all copies are printed.  
Reserve Job Expiration  
Store print jobs for printing at a later time.  
Note: The print jobs are held until deleted from the Held Jobs menu.  
Notes:  
Confidential, Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to  
process additional held jobs.  
You can set the printer to store print jobs in the printer memory until you start the print job from the printer  
control panel.  
All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.  
2 Touch Submit.  
Printing confidential and other held jobs  
Note: Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after printing. Repeat and Reserve  
jobs are held in the printer until you delete them.  
For Windows users  
1 With a document open, click File > Print.  
2 Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
3 Click Print and Hold.  
4 Select the print job type (Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential  
print job, also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
5 Click OK or Print.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing  
105  
6 From the printer home screen, release the print job.  
For confidential print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential Jobs > enter the PIN > Print  
For other print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job > specify the number of copies > Print  
For Macintosh users  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the print options or Copies & Pages popup menu, choose Job Routing.  
3 Select the print job type (Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential  
print job, also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
4 Click OK or Print.  
5 From the printer home screen, release the print job.  
For confidential print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential Jobs > enter the PIN > Print  
For other print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job > specify the number of copies > Print  
Modifying confidential print settings  
Note: This feature is available only in network printers or printers connected to print servers.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Configuration > Other Settings tab > Security > Confidential Print Setup.  
3 Modify the settings:  
Set a maximum number of PIN entry attempts. When a user exceeds that number, all of the jobs for that user  
are deleted.  
Set an expiration time for confidential print jobs. When a user has not printed the jobs within that time, all of  
the jobs for that user are deleted.  
4 Save the modified settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing  
106  
Printing information pages  
Printing a font sample list  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Reports > Print Fonts  
2 Touch PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.  
Printing a directory list  
A directory list shows the resources stored in a flash memory or in the printer hard disk.  
From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Reports > Print Directory  
Canceling a print job  
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, touch Cancel Jobs or press  
on the keypad.  
2 Touch the print job you want to cancel, and then touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
Canceling a print job from the computer  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Doubleclick the printer icon.  
3 Select the print job you want to cancel.  
4 Click Delete.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Printing  
107  
For Macintosh users  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan > select your printer > Open Print Queue  
System Preferences > Print & Fax > select your printer > Open Print Queue  
2 From the printer window, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying  
108  
Copying  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
Making copies  
Making a quick copy  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Note: To avoid a cropped image, make sure the size of the original document and the size of the copy paper are  
the same.  
3 From the printer control panel, press  
.
Copying using the ADF  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 Adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
109  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > specify the copy settings > Copy It  
Copying using the scanner glass  
1 Place an original document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > specify the copy settings > Copy It  
If you have more pages to scan, then place the next document on the scanner glass, and then touch Scan the next  
page.  
3 Touch Finish the Job.  
Copying photos  
1 Place a photo facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Content > Photo >  
3 From the Content Source menu, select the appropriate setting that best matches the original photo.  
4 Touch  
> Copy It  
Note: If you have more photos to copy, then place the next photo on the scanner glass, and then touch Scan the  
next page.  
5 Touch Finish the Job.  
Copying on specialty media  
Copying on transparencies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > select the size of the original document >  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
110  
3 Navigate to:  
Copy to > select the tray that contains transparencies > Copy It  
If there are no trays that contain transparencies, then navigate to:  
Manual Feeder >  
> select the size of the transparencies >  
> Transparency >  
4 Load transparencies into the multipurpose feeder, and then touch Copy It.  
Copying on letterhead  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > select the size of the original document >  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to > select the tray containing the letterhead > Copy It  
5 If there are no trays that support letterhead, then navigate to:  
Manual Feeder > select the size of the letterhead > Letterhead  
6 Load the letterhead faceup, top edge first into the multipurpose feeder, and then touch Copy It.  
Creating a copy shortcut using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, touch Copy.  
2 Adjust the copy settings, and then touch Save as Shortcut.  
Note: If you change the settings after the copy shortcut has been created, then the settings are not saved.  
3 Type a unique name for the shortcut, and then touch Done.  
4 Verify that the shortcut name is correct, and then touch OK.  
If the shortcut name is incorrect, then touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
Notes:  
The shortcut name appears in the Copy Shortcuts icon on the printer home screen.  
You can use the shortcut when copying another document using the same settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
111  
Customizing copy settings  
Copying to a different size  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > select the size of the original document >  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to > select a new size for the copy >  
> Copy It  
Making copies using paper from a selected tray  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > select the size of the original document >  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to > select the tray containing the paper type you want to use >  
5 Touch Copy It.  
Copying different paper sizes  
Use the ADF to copy original documents with different paper sizes. Depending on the paper sizes loaded and the “Copy  
to” and “Copy from” settings, each copy is either printed on mixed paper sizes (Example 1) or scaled to fit a single paper  
size (Example 2).  
Example 1: Copying on mixed paper sizes  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
112  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > Mixed Sizes >  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to > Auto Size Match >  
> Copy It  
The scanner identifies the different paper sizes as they are scanned. Copies are printed on mixed paper sizes  
corresponding to the paper sizes of the original document.  
Example 2: Copying on a single paper size  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Copy from > Mixed Sizes >  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to > Letter >  
> Copy It  
The scanner identifies the different paper sizes as they are scanned, and then scales the mixed paper sizes to fit on  
the paper size selected.  
Copying on both sides of the paper (duplexing)  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
113  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Sides (Duplex) > select the preferred duplexing method  
Note: For the preferred duplexing method, the first number represents sides of the original documents while  
the second number represents sides of the copy. For example, select “2 sided to 2 sided” if you have two-sided  
original documents and you want twosided copies.  
4 Touch  
> Copy It.  
Reducing or enlarging copies  
Copies can be scaled from 25% to 400% of the original document size.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 From the Scale area, touch  
or  
to decrease or increase the value by 1%.  
Touching “Copy to” or “Copy from” after setting Scale manually changes the scale value back to Auto.  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. This automatically adjusts the scan image of the original document to  
fit the size of the paper onto which you are copying.  
5 Touch Copy It.  
Adjusting copy quality  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Content  
4 Touch the button that best represents the content type of the document you are copying.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and  
animations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
114  
5 Touch  
.
6 Touch the button that best represents the content source of the document you are copying.  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from a film.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
7 Touch  
> Copy It.  
Collating copies  
If you print multiple copies of a document, then you can choose to print the copies as a set (collated) or to print the  
copies as groups of pages (not collated).  
Collated  
Not collated  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > enter the number of copies > Collate > select the preferred order of pages >  
> Copy It  
Placing separator sheets between copies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
115  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Advanced Options > Separator Sheets  
Note: Set Collate to “1,2,3 1,2,3” to place separator sheets between copies. If Collate is set to “1,1,1 2,2,2,”  
then the separator sheets are added to the end of the copy job. For more information, see “Collating copies” on  
4 Select one of the following:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Off  
5 Touch  
> Copy It.  
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet  
In order to save paper, you can copy either two or four consecutive pages of a multiplepage document onto a single  
sheet of paper.  
Notes:  
Make sure to set the paper size to letter, legal, A4, or JIS B5.  
Make sure to set the copy size to 100%.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Advanced Options > Paper Saver > select the output you want >  
> Copy It  
Note: If Paper Saver is set to Off, then the Print Page Borders option is unavailable.  
Creating a custom copy job  
The custom copy job or job build is used to combine one or more sets of original documents into a single copy job. Each  
set may be scanned using different job parameters. When a copy job is submitted and Custom Job is enabled, the  
scanner scans the first set of original documents using the specified settings, and then it scans the next set with the  
same or different settings.  
The definition of a set depends on the scan source:  
If you scan a document on the scanner glass, then a set consists of one page.  
If you scan multiple pages using the ADF, then a set consists of all scanned pages until the ADF tray becomes empty.  
If you scan one page using the ADF, then a set consists of one page.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
116  
For example:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Advanced Options > Custom Job > On >  
> Copy It  
Note: When the end of a set is reached, the scan screen appears.  
4 Load the next document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass, and then touch  
Scan from automatic feeder or Scan from flatbed.  
Note: Change the scan job settings, if necessary.  
5 If you have another document to scan, then repeat the previous step. Otherwise, touch Finish the job.  
Placing information on copies  
Placing a header or footer on pages  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Advanced Options > Header/Footer > select where you want to place the header or footer > select the type  
of header or footer you want  
4 Enter the required information depending on the header or footer you selected, and then touch Done.  
5 Touch  
, and then press  
.
Placing an overlay message on each page  
An overlay message can be placed on each page. The message choices are Urgent, Confidential, Copy, Custom, and  
Draft.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copying  
117  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Copy > Advanced Options > Overlay > select overlay message > Done > Copy It  
Canceling a copy job  
Canceling a copy job while the original document is in the ADF  
When the ADF begins processing a document, touch Cancel Job on the printer control panel.  
Canceling a copy job while copying pages using the scanner glass  
From the home screen, touch Cancel Job.  
Cancelingappears on the display. When the job is canceled, the Copy screen appears.  
Canceling a copy job while pages are being printed  
1 From the home screen, touch Cancel Job, or press  
2 Touch the job you want to cancel.  
3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
on the keypad.  
Understanding the copy options  
Copy from  
This option opens a screen where you can select the paper size of the original document.  
Touch the paper size that matches the original document.  
To copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes with the same width, touch Mixed Sizes.  
To set the printer to automatically detect the size of the original document, touch Auto Size Sense.  
Copy to  
This option opens a screen where you can enter the paper size and type on which your copies will be printed.  
Touch the paper size and type that matches the paper loaded.  
If the settings for “Copy from” and “Copy to” are different, then the printer automatically adjusts the Scale setting  
to accommodate the difference.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Copying  
118  
If the paper type or size that you want to copy onto is not loaded in one of the trays, then touch Manual Feeder,  
and manually load the paper in the multipurpose feeder.  
When “Copy to” is set to Auto Size Match, each copy matches the paper size of the original document. If a matching  
paper size is not in one of the trays, then Paper size not foundappears and prompts to load a paper in a  
tray or multipurpose feeder.  
Scale  
This option lets you scale the document from 25% to 400% of the original document size. You can also set automatic  
scaling.  
When copying to a different paper size, such as from legalsize to lettersize paper, set the “Copy from” and “Copy  
to” paper sizes automatically to scale the scan image to fit the size of the paper onto which you are copying.  
To decrease or increase the value by 1%, touch  
or  
on the printer control panel. To make a continuous  
decrease or increase in value, hold the button for two seconds or more.  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark the copies are in relation to the original document.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option lets you make one- or two-sided copies from one- or two-sided original documents.  
Collate  
This option keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies of the document.  
Copies  
This option lets you set the number of copies to be printed.  
Content  
This option lets you set the original document type and source.  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Copying  
119  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from film.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Save As Shortcut  
This option lets you save the current settings by assigning a shortcut name.  
Note: Selecting this option automatically assigns the next available shortcut number.  
Using the advanced options  
Select from the following settings:  
Advanced Duplex—This specifies the document orientation, whether documents are one-sided or two-sided, and  
how documents are bound.  
Advanced Imaging—This changes or adjusts Auto Center, Background Removal, Color Balance, Color Dropout,  
Contrast, Mirror Image, Negative Image, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, Sharpness, and Temperature settings  
before you copy the document.  
Create Booklet—This creates a booklet. You can choose between onesided and twosided.  
Note: This option appears only when a printer hard disk is installed.  
Cover Page Setup—This sets up the cover page of copies and booklets.  
Custom Job—This combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job.  
Edge Erase—This removes smudges or marks around the edges of a document. You can choose to remove an equal  
area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the area  
selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Header/Footer—This inserts date or time, page number, Bates number, or custom text, and then prints them in  
the specified header or footer location.  
Margin Shift—This increases or reduces the size of the margin of a page by shifting the scanned image. Touch  
or  
to set the margin you want. If the additional margin is too large, then the copy will be cropped.  
Overlay—This creates a watermark (or message) that overlays the content of your copy. You can choose from  
Urgent, Confidential, Copy, and Draft, or you can enter a custom message in the ”Enter custom text” field. The word  
you pick will appear, faintly, in large print across each page.  
Paper Saver—This prints two or more pages of an original document on the same page. Paper Saver is also called  
N-up printing where N stands for the number of pages. For example, 2-up would print two pages of your document  
on a single page, and 4-up would print four pages of your document on a single page.  
Separator Sheets—This places a blank sheet of paper between copies, pages, or print jobs. The separator sheets  
can be drawn from a tray that contains a type or color of paper that is different from the paper your copies are  
printed on.  
Multifeed Sensor—This detects when the ADF picks more than one sheet of paper at a time, and then displays an  
error message.  
Note: This option is supported only in select printer models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mailing  
120  
E-mailing  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
Setting up the printer to e-mail  
Setting up the e-mail function  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > E-mail/FTP Settings > E-mail Settings.  
3 Enter the appropriate information, and then click Submit.  
Configuring email settings  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > E-mail/FTP Settings > E-mail Settings.  
3 Enter the appropriate information, and then click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
E-mailing  
121  
Creating an e-mail shortcut  
Creating an e-mail shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 From the Other Settings column, click Manage Shortcuts > E-mail Shortcut Setup.  
4 Typeaunique nameforthe emailrecipient, andthentype theemail address. Ifyou are enteringmultipleaddresses,  
then separate each address with a comma.  
5 Click Add.  
Creating an e-mail shortcut using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
E-mail > Recipient > type an email address  
To create a group of recipients, touch Next address, and then type the next recipient’s e-mail address.  
2 Touch Subject, then type the email subject, and then touch Done.  
3 Touch Message, then type your message, and then touch Done.  
4 Adjust the email settings.  
Note: If you change the settings after the email shortcut has been created, then the settings are not saved.  
5 Touch  
.
6 Type a unique name for the shortcut, and then touch Done.  
7 Verify that the shortcut name is correct, and then touch OK.  
If the shortcut name is incorrect, then touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
Notes:  
The shortcut name appears in the E-mail Shortcuts icon on the printer home screen.  
You can use the shortcut when emailing another document using the same settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mailing  
122  
E-mailing a document  
You can use the printer to email scanned documents to one or more recipients in a number of ways. You can type the  
email address, use a shortcut number, or use the address book. You can also use the Multi Send or MyShortcut  
application from the printer home screen. For more information, see the "Activating the home screen applications"  
section.  
Sending an e-mail using the printer control panel  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Note: To avoid a cropped image, make sure that the size of the original document and the copy paper size are  
the same.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
E-mail > Recipient(s)  
4 Type the email address, or press # using the keypad, and then enter the shortcut number.  
Notes:  
To enter additional recipients, touch Next address, and then enter the address or shortcut number you want  
to add.  
You can also enter an email address using the address book.  
5 Touch Done > Send It.  
Sending an email using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press #, then enter the shortcut number using the keypad, and then touch  
.
Note: To enter additional recipients, touch Next address, and then enter the address or shortcut number that  
you want to add.  
4 Touch Send It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mailing  
123  
Sending an email using the address book  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
E-mail > Recipient(s) >  
> type the name of the recipient > Search  
4 Touch the name of the recipient.  
Note: To enter additional recipients, touch Next address, and then enter the address or shortcut number that  
you want to add, or search the address book.  
5 Touch Done.  
Customizing e-mail settings  
Adding e-mail subject and message information  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
E-mail > Recipient(s) > type the email address > Done  
4 Touch Subject, then type the email subject, and then touch Done.  
5 Touch Message, then type your message, and then touch Done.  
Changing the output file type  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
E-mailing  
124  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
E-mail > Recipient(s) > type the email address > Done > Send as  
4 Touch the button that represents the file type you want to send.  
PDF—Create a single file with multiple pages.  
Secure PDF—Create an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access.  
TIFF—Create multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  
Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
JPEG—Create and attach a separate file for each page of your original document, viewable by most Web  
browsers and graphics programs.  
XPS—Create a single XML Paper Specification (XPS) file with multiple pages, viewable using an Internet  
Explorerhosted viewer and the .NET Framework, or by downloading a thirdparty standalone viewer.  
5 Touch  
> Send It.  
Note: If you selected Secure PDF, then you will be prompted to enter your password twice.  
Canceling an e-mail  
When using the ADF, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears.  
When using the scanner glass, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears, or while Scan the Next Page/  
Finish the Jobappears.  
Understanding the e-mail options  
Recipient(s)  
This option lets you enter the recipient of your e-mail. You may enter multiple email addresses.  
Subject  
This option lets you type a subject line for your e-mail.  
Message  
This option lets you type a message that will be sent with your scanned attachment.  
File Name  
This option lets you customize the attachment file name.  
Original Size  
This option lets you set the paper size of the documents you are going to email. When Original Size is set to Mixed  
Sizes, you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper sizes (letterand legalsize pages).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
E-mailing  
125  
Resolution  
This option lets you adjust the output quality of your e-mail. Increasing the image resolution increases the e-mail file  
size and the time needed to scan your original document. Decreasing the image resolution reduces the file size.  
Content  
This option lets you set the original document type and source.  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from film.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Save As Shortcut  
This option lets you save the current settings as a shortcut by assigning a shortcut name.  
Note: Selecting this option automatically assigns the next available shortcut number.  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark your scanned documents are in relation to the original document.  
Send As  
This option lets you set the output type for the scan image.  
Select one of the following:  
PDF—Use this to create a single file with multiple pages.  
Note: PDF is the factory default setting.  
Secure PDF—Use this to create an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access.  
TIFF—Use this to create multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the  
Embedded Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
E-mailing  
126  
JPEG—Use this to create and attach a separate file for each page of your original document.  
XPS—Use this to create a single XPS file with multiple pages.  
Page Setup  
This option lets you change the following settings:  
Sides (Duplex)—This specifies if the original document is printed on only one side or on both sides of the paper.  
This also identifies what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the e-mail.  
Orientation—This specifies the orientation of the original document, and then changes the Sides (Duplex) and  
Binding settings to match the orientation.  
Binding—This specifies if the original document is bound on the longedge or shortedge side.  
Scan Preview  
This option lets you view the first page of the image before it is included in the e-mail. When the first page is scanned,  
the scanning is paused and a preview image appears.  
Note: This option appears only when a working printer hard disk is installed.  
Using the advanced options  
Select from the following settings:  
Advanced Imaging—This adjusts the Background Removal, Color Balance, Color Dropout, Contrast, JPEG Quality,  
Mirror Image, Negative Image, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, Sharpness, and Temperature settings before you  
email the document.  
Custom Job—This combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job.  
Edge Erase—This removes smudges or marks around the edges of a document. You can choose to remove an equal  
area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the area  
selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Transmission Log—This prints the transmission log or transmission error log.  
Multifeed Sensor—This detects when the ADF picks more than one sheet of paper at a time, and then displays an  
error message.  
Note: This option is supported only in select printer models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
127  
Faxing  
Note: Fax capabilities may not be available on all printer models.  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
Setting up the printer to fax  
The following connection methods may not be applicable in all countries or regions.  
Note: During the initial printer setup, deselect Fax and any other function you plan to set up later, and then touch  
Continue. The indicator light may blink red if the fax function is enabled and not fully set up.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch cables or the printer in the area shown while actively sending or  
receiving a fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
128  
Initial fax setup  
Many countries and regions require outgoing faxes to contain the following information in a margin at the top or bottom  
of each transmitted page, or on the first page of the transmission: fax name (identification of the business, other entity,  
or individual sending the message) and fax number (telephone number of the sending fax machine, business, other  
To enter your fax setup information, use the printer control panel, or use your browser to access the Embedded Web  
Server and then enter the Settings menu.  
Note: If you do not have a TCP/IP environment, then you must use the printer control panel to enter your fax setup  
information.  
Using the printer control panel for fax setup  
When the printer is turned on for the first time, a series of startup screens appear. If the printer has fax capabilities,  
then the Fax Name and Fax Number screens appear.  
1 When the Fax Name screen appears, do the following:  
a Enter the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes.  
b Enter the fax name, and then touch Submit.  
2 When the Fax Number screen appears, enter the fax number, and then touch Submit.  
Using the Embedded Web Server for fax setup  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
3 In the Fax Name field, type the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes.  
4 In the Fax Number field, enter the printer fax number.  
5 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
129  
Choosing a fax connection  
Scenario 1: Standard telephone line  
Setup 1: Printer is connected to a dedicated fax line  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
130  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
Tips for this setup:  
You can set the printer to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On) or manually (Auto Answer Off).  
If you want to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On), then set the printer to pick up on any number of rings  
that you want.  
Setup 2: Printer is sharing the line with an answering machine  
Connected to the same telephone wall jack  
PHONE  
LINE  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
3 Connect the answering machine to the  
port of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
131  
Connected to different wall jacks  
PHONE  
LINE  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
Tips for this setup:  
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then you need to set the printer to receive faxes automatically  
(Auto Answer On).  
Set the printer to pick up calls two rings after the answering machine. For example, if the answering machine picks  
up calls after four rings, then set the printer to pick up after six rings. This way, the answering machine picks up  
calls first and your voice calls are received. If the call is a fax, then the printer detects the fax signal on the line and  
takes over the call.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
132  
If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service provided by your telephone company, then make sure that you set the  
correct ring pattern for the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you have set it to receive  
faxes automatically.  
Setup 3: Printer is sharing the line with a telephone subscribed to voice mail service  
0 2  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
3 Connect the telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
133  
Tips for this setup:  
This setup works best if you subscribe to a distinctive ring service. If you have distinctive ring service, then make  
sure that you set the correct ring pattern for the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you  
have set it to receive faxes automatically.  
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then you need to set the printer to receive faxes manually  
(Auto Answer Off).  
When you answer the telephone and you hear fax tones, press *9* or the manual answer code on the telephone  
to receive the fax.  
You can also set the printer to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On), but you need to turn off the voice  
mail service when you are expecting a fax. This setting works best if you are using voice mail more often than fax.  
Scenario 2: Digital Subscriber Line (DSL)  
A Digital Subscriber Line splits your regular telephone line into two channels: voice and Internet. Telephone and fax  
signals travel through the voice channel, and Internet signals pass through the other channel. This way, you can use  
the same line for analog voice calls (including faxes) and digital Internet access.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
134  
To minimize interference between the two channels and ensure a quality connection, you need to install a DSL filter  
for the analog devices (fax machine, telephone, answering machine) in your network. Interference causes noise and  
static on the telephone, failed and poor quality faxes for the printer, and slow Internet connection on your computer.  
To install a filter for the printer:  
1 Connect the line port of the DSL filter to the wall jack.  
2 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer. Connect the other  
end to the phone port on the DSL filter.  
3 To continue using a computer for Internet access, connect the computer to the DSL HPN port on the DSL filter.  
4 To connect a telephone to the printer, remove any installed adapter plug from the  
port of the printer, and then  
connect the telephone to the port.  
Scenario 3: VoIP telephone service  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
135  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the port labeled Phone Line 1 or Phone Port on the VoIP adapter.  
Note: The port labeled Phone Line 2 or Fax Port is not always active. VoIP providers may charge additional cost  
for activation of the second phone port.  
3 Connect the telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Tips for this setup:  
To make sure that the phone port on the VoIP adapter is active, plug an analog telephone into the phone port, and  
then listen for a dial tone. If you hear a dial tone, then the port is active.  
If you need two phone ports for your devices, but do not want to pay additional cost, then do not plug the printer  
into the second phone port. You can use a phone splitter. Plug the phone splitter into the port labeled Phone Line  
1 or Phone Port, and then plug the printer and telephone into the splitter.  
Note: Make sure you use a phone splitter, not a line splitter. To make sure that you are using the correct  
splitter, plug an analog telephone into the splitter and then listen for a dial tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
136  
Scenario 4: Digital telephone service through a cable provider  
Setup 1: Printer is connected directly to a cable modem  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the port labeled Phone Line 1 or Phone Port on the cable modem.  
Note: The port labeled Phone Line 2 or Fax Port is not always active. VoIP providers may charge additional cost  
for activation of the second phone port.  
3 Connect your analog telephone phone to the  
port of the printer.  
Notes:  
To make sure that the telephone port on the cable modem is active, plug an analog telephone into the  
telephone port, and then listen for a dial tone. If you hear a dial tone, then the port is active.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
137  
If you need two telephone ports for your devices, but do not want to pay additional cost, then do not plug the  
printer into the second telephone port. You can use a phone splitter. Plug the phone splitter into the Phone Line  
1 or Phone Port, and then plug the printer and telephone into the splitter.  
Make sure you use a phone splitter, not a line splitter. To make sure that you are using the correct splitter, plug  
an analog telephone into the splitter and then listen for a dial tone.  
Setup 2: Printer is connected to a wall jack; cable modem is installed elsewhere in the facility  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog telephone wall jack.  
3 Connect your analog telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Scenario 5: Countries or regions with different telephone wall jacks and plugs  
Some countries or regions may have different types of telephone wall jack connectors than those that came with the  
printer. The standard wall jack adopted by most countries or regions is RJ-11. Your printer comes with the RJ-11 jack  
and a telephone cable with the RJ-11 plug.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
138  
If the wall jack or equipment in your facility is not compatible with this type of connection, then you need to use a  
telephone adapter. An adapter for your country or region may not come with your printer, and you may need to  
purchase it separately.  
There may be an adapter plug installed in the  
that has a cascaded or serial wiring scheme, then do not remove the adapter plug from the  
port of the printer. If you are using a telephone adapter or a facility  
port of the printer.  
Part name  
Part number  
Lexmark adapter plug  
40X8519  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
139  
Connecting the printer to a nonRJ11 wall jack  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to the wall jack.  
3 If you want to connect another device (telephone or answering machine) to the same wall jack, and if the device  
has a nonRJ11 connector, then connect it directly to the telephone adapter.  
Notes:  
The  
port of the printer may have an adapter plug for use with the adapter. Do not remove the plug from  
the  
port of the printer.  
In some countries or regions, the printer may not come with a telephone adapter or an adapter plug.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
140  
Connecting the printer to a wall jack in Germany  
The German wall jack has two kinds of ports. The N ports are for fax machines, modems, and answering machines. The  
F port is for telephones.  
N F N  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
141  
Connect the printer to any of the N ports.  
N
F
N
PHONE  
LINE  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to an N port.  
3 If you want to connect a telephone and answering machine to the same wall jack, then connect the devices as  
shown.  
Note: Do not remove the adapter plug from the  
port of the printer if you are connecting to a serial or cascaded  
telephone system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
142  
Connecting to a distinctive ring service  
A distinctive ring service may be available from your telephone company. This service lets you have multiple telephone  
numbers on one telephone line, with each telephone number having a different ring pattern. This may be useful for  
distinguishing between fax and voice calls. If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service, then follow these steps to  
connect the equipment:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the printer LINE port  
.
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog telephone wall jack.  
3 Change the distinctive rings setting to match the setting you want for the printer to answer.  
Note: The factory default setting for distinctive rings is On. This sets the printer to answer single, double, and  
triple ring patterns.  
a From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup > Answer On  
b Select the pattern setting you want to change, and then touch Submit.  
Setting the outgoing fax name and number  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
3 In the Fax Name field, type the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes.  
4 In the Fax Number field, enter the printer fax number.  
5 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
143  
Setting the date and time  
You can set the date and time so that they are printed on every fax you send.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Security > Set Date and Time.  
3 In the Manually Set Date & Time field, enter the current date and time.  
4 Click Submit.  
Note: It is recommended to use the network time.  
Configuring the printer to observe daylight saving time  
The printer can be set to automatically adjust for daylight saving time:  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Security > Set Date and Time.  
3 Select the Automatically Observe DST check box, and then enter the DST start and end dates in the Custom Time  
Zone Setup section.  
4 Click Submit.  
Sending a fax  
You can use the printer to send a fax to one or more recipients in a number of ways. You can type the email address,  
use a shortcut number, or use the address book. You can also use the Multi Send or MyShortcut application from the  
printer home screen. For more information, see the "Activating the home screen applications" section of the User’s  
Guide.  
Sending a fax using the printer control panel  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
144  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Enter the fax number or a shortcut.  
Note: To add recipients, touch Next number, and then enter the recipient's telephone number or shortcut  
number, or search the address book.  
5 Touch Fax It.  
Sending a fax using the computer  
The printer driver fax option lets you send a print job to the printer, which sends the job as a fax. The fax option works  
as a normal fax machine, but is controlled through the printer driver instead of the printer control panel.  
1 With a document open, click File > Print.  
2 Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
3 Navigate to:  
Fax tab > Enable fax  
4 Enter the recipient fax number or numbers in the “Fax number(s)” field.  
Note: Fax numbers can be entered manually or by using the Phone Book feature  
5 If necessary, enter a prefix in the “Dialing prefix” field.  
6 Select the appropriate paper size and page orientation.  
7 If you want to include a cover page with the fax, then select Include cover page with fax, and then enter the  
appropriate information.  
8 Click OK.  
Notes:  
The Fax option is available for use only with the PostScript driver or the Universal Fax Driver. For information on  
installing these drivers, see the Software CD.  
The Fax option must be configured and enabled in the PostScript driver under the Configuration tab before it  
can be used.  
If the Always display settings prior to faxing check box is selected, then you are prompted to verify the  
recipient information before the fax is sent. If this check box is cleared, then the queued document is sent  
automatically as a fax when you click OK on the Fax tab.  
Sending a fax using a shortcut number  
Fax shortcuts are like the speed dial numbers on a telephone or a fax machine. A shortcut number (1–999) can contain  
a single recipient or multiple recipients.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
145  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, press #, and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad.  
4 Touch Fax It.  
Sending a fax using the address book  
The address book lets you search for bookmarks and network directory servers. For more information on enabling the  
address book feature, contact your system support person.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Fax >  
> type the name of the recipient > Search  
Note: You can search only for one name at a time.  
4 Touch the name of the recipient, and then touch Fax It.  
Sending a fax at a scheduled time  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Fax > enter the fax number > Options > Delayed Send  
Note: If Fax Mode is set to Fax Server, then the Delayed Send button does not appear. Faxes waiting for  
transmission are listed in the fax queue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
146  
4 Specify the time the fax will be transmitted, and then touch  
.
5 Touch Fax It.  
Note: The document is scanned, and then faxed at the scheduled time.  
Creating shortcuts  
Creating a fax destination shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
Assign a shortcut number to a single fax number or a group of fax numbers.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Manage Shortcuts > Fax Shortcut Setup.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, then contact your system support  
person.  
3 Type a name for the shortcut, and then enter the fax number.  
Notes:  
To create a multiplenumber shortcut, enter the fax numbers for the group.  
Separate each fax number in the group with a semicolon (;).  
4 Assign a shortcut number.  
Note: If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
5 Click Add.  
Creating a fax destination shortcut using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, touch Fax, and then enter the fax number.  
Note: To create a group of fax numbers, touch Next number, and then enter the next fax number.  
2 Touch  
.
3 Type a unique name for the shortcut, and then touch Done.  
4 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct, and then touch OK.  
Note: If the name or number is incorrect, then touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
147  
Customizing fax settings  
Changing the fax resolution  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Fax > enter the fax number > Options  
4 From the Resolution area, touch the arrows to select the resolution you want.  
Note: Select a resolution from Standard (fastest speed) to Ultra Fine (best quality at a reduced speed).  
5 Touch Fax It.  
Making a fax lighter or darker  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
Fax > enter the fax number > Options  
4 Adjust the fax darkness, and then touch Fax It.  
Viewing a fax log  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Reports.  
3 Click Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
148  
Blocking junk faxes  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup > Block No Name Fax.  
Notes:  
This option blocks all incoming faxes that have a private caller ID or have no fax name.  
In the Banned Fax List field, enter the phone numbers or type the fax names of specific fax callers you want  
to block.  
Canceling an outgoing fax  
Canceling a fax while the original documents are still scanning  
When using the ADF, touch Cancel Job on the printer control panel while Scanningappears.  
When using the scanner glass, touch Cancel Job on the printer control panel while Scanningappears or while  
Scan the Next Pageand Finish the Jobappear.  
Canceling a fax after the original documents have been scanned to memory  
1 On the home screen, touch Cancel Jobs.  
The Cancel Jobs screen appears.  
2 Touch the job or jobs you want to cancel.  
Only three jobs appear on the screen; touch the down arrow until the job you want appears, and then touch the  
job you want to cancel.  
3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
The Deleting Selected Jobs screen appears, the selected jobs are deleted, and then the home screen appears.  
Holding and forwarding faxes  
Holding faxes  
This option lets you hold received faxes from printing until they are released. Held faxes can be released manually or  
at a scheduled day or time.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Faxing  
149  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup > Holding Faxes.  
3 From the Held Fax Mode menu, select one of the following:  
Off  
Always On  
Manual  
Scheduled  
4 If you selected Scheduled, then continue with the following steps:  
a Click Fax Holding Schedule.  
b From the Action menu, select Hold faxes.  
c From the Time menu, select the time you want the held faxes released.  
d From the Day(s) menu, select the day you want the held faxes released.  
5 Click Add.  
Forwarding a fax  
This option lets you print and forward received faxes to a fax number, email address, FTP site, or LDSS.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings.  
3 From the Fax Forwarding menu, select Print, Print and Forward, or Forward.  
4 From the “Forward to” menu, select Fax, Email, FTP, LDSS, or eSF.  
5 In the “Forward to Shortcut” field, enter the shortcut number where you want the fax forwarded.  
Note: The shortcut number must be valid for the setting selected in the “Forward to” menu.  
6 Click Submit.  
Understanding the fax options  
Resolution  
This option lets you adjust the quality of the fax output. Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the  
time needed to scan your original document. Decreasing the image resolution reduces the file size.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
150  
Select one of the following:  
Standard—Use this when faxing most documents.  
Fine 200 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with small prints.  
Super fine 300 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with fine details.  
Ultra fine 600 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with pictures or photos.  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark the faxes are in relation to the original document.  
Page Setup  
This option lets you change the following settings:  
Sides (Duplex)—This specifies if the original document is printed on one side or on both sides of the page (duplex).  
This also identifies what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the fax.  
Orientation—This specifies the orientation of the original document, and then changes the Sides (Duplex) and  
Binding settings to match the orientation.  
Binding—This specifies if the original document is bound on the longedge or shortedge side.  
Content  
This option lets you specify the content type and source of the original document.  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from film.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Delayed Send  
This option lets you send a fax at a later time or date.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
151  
Scan Preview  
This option lets you view the first page of the image before it is included in the fax. When the first page is scanned, the  
scanning is paused and a preview image appears.  
Note: This option appears only when a working printer hard disk is installed.  
Using the advanced options  
Select from the following settings:  
Advanced Imaging—This adjusts the Background Removal, Color Balance, Color Dropout, Contrast, Mirror Image,  
Negative Image, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, Sharpness, and Temperature settings before you fax the  
document.  
Custom Job—This combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job.  
Edge Erase—This removes smudges or marks around the edges of a document. You can choose to remove an equal  
area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase erases whatever is within the area  
selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Transmission Log—This prints the transmission log or transmission error log.  
Multifeed Sensor—This detects when the ADF picks more than one sheet of paper at a time, and then shows an  
error message.  
Note: This option is supported only in select printer models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning  
152  
Scanning  
Using Scan to Network  
Scan to Network lets you scan your documents to network destinations specified by your system support person. After  
the destinations (shared network folders) have been established on the network, the setup process for the application  
involves installing and configuring the application on the appropriate printer using its Embedded Web Server. For more  
Scanning to an FTP address  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) server. Only one FTP address may be  
sent to the server at a time.  
When an FTP destination has been configured by your system support person, the name of the destination becomes  
available as a shortcut number, or it is listed as a profile under the Held Jobs icon. An FTP destination could also be  
another PostScript printer; for example, a color document can be scanned and then sent to a color printer.  
Creating shortcuts  
Instead of entering the entire FTP site address on the printer control panel each time you want to send a document to  
an FTP server, you can create a permanent FTP destination and assign a shortcut number. There are two methods for  
creating shortcut numbers: using the Embedded Web Server and using the printer control panel.  
Creating an FTP shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Scanning  
153  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Navigate to:  
Settings > Other Settings area > Manage Shortcuts > FTP Shortcut Setup  
3 Enter the appropriate information.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, then contact your system support  
person.  
4 Enter a shortcut number.  
Note: If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
5 Click Add.  
Creating an FTP shortcut using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
FTP > FTP > type the FTP address >  
> type a name for the shortcut > Done  
2 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct, and then touch OK.  
Notes:  
If the name or number is incorrect, then touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
Scanning to an FTP address  
You can use the printer to send scanned documents to an FTP address in a number of ways. You can type the FTP  
address, use a shortcut number, or use the address book. You can also use the Multi Send, Scan to Network, or  
MyShortcut application from the printer home screen. For more information, see the "Activating the home screen  
applications" section of the User’s Guide.  
Scanning to an FTP address using the printer control panel  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
FTP > FTP > type the FTP address > Done > Send It  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning  
154  
Scanning to an FTP address using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, press # on the keypad, and then enter the FTP shortcut number.  
4 Touch  
> Send It.  
Scanning an FTP using the address book  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the home screen, navigate to:  
FTP > FTP >  
> type the name of the recipient > Search  
4 Touch the name of the recipient.  
Note: To search for additional recipients, touch New Search, and then type the name of the next recipient.  
5 Touch  
> Send It.  
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning  
155  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a computer or a flash drive. The computer does not have to be directly  
connected to the printer for you to receive scan to computer images. You can scan the document back to the computer  
over the network by creating a scan profile on the computer and then downloading the profile to the printer.  
Scanning to a computer using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Scan Profile > Create Scan Profile.  
3 Select your scan settings, and then click Next.  
4 Select a location on your computer where you want to save the scan image.  
5 Type a scan name, and then a user name.  
Note: The scan name is the name that appears in the Scan Profile list on the display.  
6 Click Submit.  
Note: Clicking Submit automatically assigns a shortcut number. You can use this shortcut number when you are  
ready to scan your documents.  
7 Review the instructions on the Scan Profile screen.  
a Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as  
magazine clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
b If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
c Do either of the following:  
Press #, and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad.  
From the home screen, navigate to:  
Held Jobs > Profiles > select your shortcut on the list  
Note: The scanner scans and sends the document to the directory you specified.  
8 View the file from the computer.  
Note: The output file is saved in the location or launched in the program you specified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scanning  
156  
Setting up Scan to Computer  
Notes:  
This feature is supported only in Windows Vista or later.  
Make sure that your computer and printer are connected to the same network.  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Depending on your operating system, click Add devices and printers, Add a device, or Add a printer.  
3 Select your printer from the list.  
Note: To identify your printer, print a network setup page, and then look for “Fully Qualified Domain Name” in  
the TCP/IP section.  
4 Click Next > Close.  
5 Depending on your device, do either of the following:.  
Press and hold the printer you want to configure.  
Rightclick the printer you want to configure.  
6 From the menu that appears, select Scan Properties or Properties, and then change the settings as necessary.  
7 From the printer control panel, touch Scan to Computer and then select from the following options:  
Scan—Scan and save the document directly to a selected location on the computer.  
Scan for Print—Scan and automatically print the document.  
Scan for Email—Attach a scanned document to an email.  
Scan for Fax—Attach a scanned document to be sent through fax.  
8 Touch Send It.  
Remote scan in progressappears on the printer display. The scanned image opens automatically on the  
computer screen.  
Scanning to a flash drive  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning  
157  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Insert the flash drive into the USB port on the front of the printer.  
Note: The USB Drive home screen appears.  
4 Select the destination folder, and then touch Scan to USB drive.  
Note: The printer goes back to the home screen after 30 seconds of inactivity.  
5 Adjust the scan settings, and then touch Scan It.  
Understanding the scan options  
FTP  
This option lets you enter the IP address for the FTP destination.  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
File Name  
This option lets you type a file name for the scan image.  
Save As Shortcut  
This option lets you save the current settings as a shortcut by assigning a shortcut name.  
Note: Selecting this option automatically assigns the next available shortcut number.  
Original Size  
This option lets you set the paper size of the documents you are going to scan. When Original Size is set to Mixed Sizes,  
you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper sizes (letterand legalsize pages).  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark the scanned documents are in relation to the original document.  
Resolution  
This option lets you adjust the output quality of your file. Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the  
time needed to scan your original document. Decreasing the image resolution reduces the file size.  
Send As  
This option lets you set the output type for the scan image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Scanning  
158  
Select one of the following:  
PDF—Use to create a single file with multiple pages.  
Secure PDF—Use to create an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access.  
TIFF—Use to create multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu, then TIFF  
saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
JPEG—Use to create and attach a separate file for each page of the original document.  
XPS—Use to create a single XPS file with multiple pages.  
Content  
This option lets you set the original document type and source.  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from film.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Page Setup  
This option lets you change the following settings:  
Sides (Duplex)—This specifies if the original document is printed on only one side or on both sides of the paper.  
Orientation—This specifies the orientation of the original document, and then changes the Sides (Duplex) and  
Binding settings to match the orientation.  
Binding—This specifies if the original document is bound on the longedge or shortedge side.  
Scan Preview  
This option lets you view the first page of the image before it is included in the file. When the first page is scanned, the  
scanning is paused and a preview image appears.  
Note: This option appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning  
159  
Using the advanced options  
Select from the following settings:  
Advanced Imaging—This adjusts the Background Removal, Color Balance, Color Dropout, Contrast, JPEG Quality,  
Mirror Image, Negative Image, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, Sharpness, and Temperature settings before you  
scan the document.  
Custom Job—This combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job.  
Edge Erase—This removes smudges or marks around the edges of a document. You can choose to remove an equal  
area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase erases whatever is within the area  
selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Transmission Log—This prints the transmission log or transmission error log.  
Multifeed Sensor—This detects when the ADF picks more than one sheet of paper at a time, and then shows an  
error message.  
Note: This option is supported only in select printer models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
160  
Understanding the printer menus  
Menus list  
Paper Menu  
Reports  
Network/Ports  
Security  
Settings  
Default Source  
Paper Size/Type  
Configure MP  
Substitute Size  
Paper Texture  
Paper Weight  
Paper Loading  
Custom Types  
Custom Names  
Custom Scan Sizes  
Custom Bin Names  
Universal Setup  
Bin Setup  
Menu Settings Page  
Device Statistics  
Active NIC  
Edit Security Setups  
General Settings  
Copy Settings  
Fax Settings  
Standard Network1  
Standard USB  
Parallel [x]  
Miscellaneous Security  
Settings  
Network Setup Page  
Confidential Print  
Disk Wiping  
Network [x] Setup  
Page  
Email Settings  
FTP Settings  
Serial [x]  
Shortcut List  
Fax Job Log  
Security Audit Log  
Set Date and Time  
Flash Drive Menu  
Print Settings  
SMTP Setup  
Fax Call Log  
Copy Shortcuts  
E-mail Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
Print Fonts  
Print Directory  
Asset Report  
Option Card Menu2  
Help  
Manage Shortcuts  
Print All Guides  
Copy Guide  
Fax Shortcuts  
A list of installed DLEs  
(Download Emulators)  
appears.  
E-mail Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Copy Shortcuts  
Profile Shortcuts  
E-mail Guide  
Fax Guide  
FTP Guide  
Print Defects Guide  
Information Guide  
Supplies Guide  
1 Depending on the printer setup, this menu appears as Standard Network or Network [x].  
2 This menu appears only when one or more DLEs are installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
161  
Paper menu  
Default Source menu  
Use  
To  
Default Source  
Tray [x]  
Set a default paper source for all print jobs.  
Notes:  
Multipurpose Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Envelope  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to "Cassette" for Multipurpose  
Feeder to appear as a menu setting.  
If two trays contain paper of the same size and type, and the trays have  
the same settings, then the trays are automatically linked. When one tray  
is empty, the print job continues using the linked tray.  
Configure MP menu  
Use  
To  
Configure MP  
Cassette  
Manual  
Determine when the printer selects paper from the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
Cassette is the factory default setting. Cassette configures the  
multipurpose feeder as the automatic paper source.  
First  
Manual sets the multipurpose feeder only for manualfeed print jobs.  
First configures the multipurpose feeder as the primary paper source.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
162  
Paper Size/Type menu  
Use  
To  
Tray [x] Size  
A4  
Specify the paper size loaded in each tray.  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JISB5  
Letter  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
default setting.  
If two trays contain paper of the same size and type, and the trays have  
the same settings, then the trays are automatically linked. The  
multipurpose feeder may also be linked. When one tray is empty, the  
print job continues using the linked tray.  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
The A6 paper size is supported only in Tray 1 and in the multipurpose  
feeder.  
Statement  
Universal  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
Tray [x] Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Specify the type of paper loaded in each tray.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting for Tray 1. Custom Type [x] is  
the factory default setting for all other trays.  
If available, a userdefined name will appear instead of Custom Type [x].  
Use this menu to configure automatic tray linking.  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
163  
Use  
To  
MP Feeder Size  
A4  
Specify the paper size loaded in the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Cassette” for MP Feeder  
Size to appear as a menu.  
Legal  
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect paper size. The  
paper size value must be set.  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
MP Feeder Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify the paper type loaded in the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
From the Paper menu, set Configure to “Cassette” for MP Feeder Type  
to appear as a menu.  
Bond  
Envelope  
Rough Envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
164  
Use  
To  
Manual Paper Size  
A4  
Specify the size of the paper being manually loaded.  
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
A5  
default setting.  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
Manual Paper Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify the paper type being manually loaded.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Manual” for Manual Paper  
Type to appear as a menu.  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Manual Envelope Size  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
Specify the envelope size being manually loaded.  
Note: 10 Envelope is the U.S. factory default setting. DL Envelope is the  
international factory default setting.  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
Manual Envelope Type  
Envelope  
Specify the envelope type being manually loaded.  
Note: Envelope is the factory default setting.  
Rough Envelope  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
165  
Use  
To  
Default ADF Media Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify the media type being loaded in the ADF.  
Note: Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Envelope  
Rough Envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Substitute Size menu  
Use  
To  
Substitute Size  
Off  
Substitute a specified paper size if the requested paper size is not available.  
Notes:  
Statement/A5  
Letter/A4  
All Listed  
All Listed is the factory default setting. All available substitutions are  
allowed.  
Off indicates that no size substitutions are allowed.  
Setting a size substitution lets the print job continue without Change  
Paperappearing.  
Paper Texture menu  
Use  
To  
Plain Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the plain paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Card Stock Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the card stock loaded in a specific tray.  
Notes:  
Normal  
Rough  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
These options appear only if card stock is supported.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
166  
Use  
To  
Transparency Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the transparencies loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Recycled Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Labels Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the labels loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Vinyl Labels Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Bond Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the bond paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Envelope Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough Envelope Texture  
Specify the relative texture of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray.  
Rough  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Letterhead Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the letterhead loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Preprinted Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the preprinted paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Colored Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the colored paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Light Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the light paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
167  
Use  
To  
Heavy Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the heavy paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough/Cotton Texture  
Specify the relative texture of the rough or cotton paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Rough  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Custom [x] Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the custom paper loaded in a specific tray.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Paper Weight menu  
Use  
To  
Plain Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the plain paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Card Stock Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the card stock loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Transparency Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the transparencies loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Recycled Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the recycled paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Labels Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the labels loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Vinyl Labels Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the vinyl labels loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Bond Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the bond paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
168  
Use  
To  
Envelope Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the envelope loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Rough Envelope Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the rough envelope loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Letterhead Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the letterhead loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Preprinted Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the preprinted paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Colored Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the colored paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Light Weight  
Specify that the weight of the paper loaded is light.  
Specify that the weight of the paper loaded is heavy.  
Light  
Heavy Weight  
Heavy  
Rough/Cotton Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the cotton or rough paper loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Custom [x] Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the custom paper loaded.  
Notes:  
Normal  
Heavy  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
The options appear only when the custom type is supported.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
169  
Paper Loading menu  
Use  
To  
Card Stock Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Card Stock  
as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Recycled Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Recycled  
as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Labels Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Labels as  
the paper type.  
Off  
Vinyl Labels Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Vinyl  
Labels as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Bond Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Bond as  
the paper type.  
Off  
Letterhead Loading  
Determineand settwo-sidedprintingfor allprintjobswith Letterhead  
as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Preprinted Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Preprinted  
as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Colored Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Colored  
as the paper type.  
Off  
Light Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Light as  
the paper type.  
Off  
Heavy Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Heavy as  
the paper type.  
Off  
Rough/Cotton Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Rough or  
Cotton as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for all Paper Loading menu selections.  
Duplex sets the printer default to twosided printing for every print job unless onesided printing is selected from  
Print Properties or the print dialog, depending on your operating system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
170  
Use  
To  
Custom [x] Loading  
Determine and set two-sided printing for all print jobs with Custom [x]  
as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Custom [x] Loading is available only when the custom type is  
supported.  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for all Paper Loading menu selections.  
Duplex sets the printer default to twosided printing for every print job unless onesided printing is selected from  
Print Properties or the print dialog, depending on your operating system.  
Custom Types menu  
Use  
To  
Custom Type [x]  
Paper  
Associate a paper or specialty media type with a factory default custom type  
name or a userdefined custom name created from the Embedded Web Server  
or from MarkVisionTM Professional.  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Rough/Cotton  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Envelope  
Notes:  
Paper is the factory default setting.  
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.  
Recycled  
Specify a paper type when Recycled is selected in other menus.  
Paper  
Notes:  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Rough/Cotton  
Labels  
Paper is the factory default setting.  
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.  
Vinyl Labels  
Envelope  
Custom Names menu  
Use  
To  
Custom Name [x]  
Specify a custom name for a paper type. This name replaces Custom Type [x] in  
the printer menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
171  
Custom Scan Sizes menu  
Use  
To  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Scan Size Name  
Media Type  
ADF Media Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify a custom scan size name, scan sizes, and options. The custom scan size  
name replaces Custom Scan Size [x] in the printer menus.  
Notes:  
ADF Media Type is the factory default setting for custom scan sizes 3, 4,  
5, and 6.  
Rough/Cotton is the factory default setting for custom scan sizes 1 and 2.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Envelope  
8.5 inches is the U.S. factory default setting for Width. 210 millimeters is  
the international factory default setting for Width.  
14 inches is the U.S. factory default setting for Height. 297 millimeters is  
the international factory default setting for Height.  
Portrait is the factory default setting for Orientation.  
Off is the factory default setting for “2 scans per side.”  
Rough Enveloope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Width  
1–8.5 inches (25–216 mm)  
Height  
1–25 inches (25–635.0 mm)  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Landscape  
2 scans per side  
Off  
On  
Custom Bin Names menu  
Use  
To  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify a custom name for the standard bin.  
Specify a custom name for Bin [x].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
172  
Universal Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Units of Measure  
Inches  
Identify the units of measure.  
Notes:  
Millimeters  
Inches is the US factory default setting.  
Millimeters is the international factory default setting.  
Portrait Width  
3–8.5 inches  
76–216 mm  
Set the portrait width.  
Notes:  
If the width exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the  
maximum width allowed.  
8.5 inches is the US factory default setting. You can increase the  
width in 0.01inch increments.  
216 mm is the international factory default setting. You can increase  
the width in 1mm increments.  
Portrait Height  
3–14.17 inches  
76–360 mm  
Set the portrait height.  
Notes:  
If the height exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the  
maximum height allowed.  
14 inches is the US factory default setting. You can increase the  
height in 0.01inch increments.  
356 mm is the international factory default setting. You can increase  
the height in 1mm increments.  
Feed Direction  
Short Edge  
Specify the feed direction if the paper can be loaded in either direction.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge appears only when the longest edge is shorter than the  
maximum width supported in the tray.  
Bin Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify the default bin.  
Notes:  
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then the  
name appears only once in the menu.  
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
[x] can be any number between 1 and 4 if the  
appropriate optional bins are installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
173  
Use  
To  
Configure Bins  
Mailbox  
Specify configuration options for bins.  
Notes:  
Link  
Mailbox is the factory default setting. This treats each  
bin as a separate mailbox.  
Mail Overflow  
Link Optional  
Type Assignment  
Link configures all available bins as one large bin.  
Mail Overflow configures each bin as a separate  
mailbox.  
Link Optional links together all available bins except  
the standard bin and only appears when at least two  
optional bins are installed.  
Type Assignment assigns each paper type to a bin or  
linked bin set.  
Bins assigned the same name are automatically  
linked unless Link Optional is selected.  
Overflow Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify an alternative bin when a designated bin is full.  
Notes:  
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then the  
name only appears once in the bin list.  
[x] can be any number between 1 and 4 if the  
appropriate optional bins are installed.  
Assign Type/Bin  
Plain Paper Bin  
Card Stock Bin  
Transparency Bin  
Recycled Bin  
Select a bin for each supported paper type.  
For each type, select from the following options:  
Disabled  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Labels Bin  
Vinyl Labels Bin  
Bond Bin  
Notes:  
Disabled is the factory default setting.  
[x] can be any number between 1 and 4 if the  
Envelope Bin  
appropriate optional bins are installed.  
Rough Envelope Bin  
Letterhead Bin  
Preprinted Bin  
Colored Bin  
If multiple bins are assigned the same name, then the  
name appears only once in the bin list.  
Light Paper Bin  
Heavy Paper Bin  
Rough/Cotton Bin  
Custom [x] Bin  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
174  
Reports menu  
Reports menu  
Use  
To  
Menu Settings Page  
Print a report containing information about the paper loaded in trays, installed  
memory, total page count, alarm settings, timeouts, printer control panel  
language, TCP/IP address, status of supplies, status of the network connection,  
and other information.  
Device Statistics  
Print a report containing printer statistics such as supply information and number  
of printed pages.  
Network Setup Page  
Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such as  
the TCP/IP address information.  
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or printers connected  
to print servers.  
Network [x] Setup Page  
Print a report containing information about the network settings of the printer,  
such as the TCP/IP address information.  
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or printers connected  
to print servers, and when there is more than one network option installed.  
Shortcut List  
Fax Job Log  
Print a report containing information about configured shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about the last 200 completed faxes.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only when Enable Job Log is set to On in the Fax  
Settings menu.  
This menu is supported only in select printer models.  
Fax Call Log  
Print a report containing information about the last 100 attempted, received, and  
blocked calls.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only when Enable Job Log is set to On in the Fax  
Settings menu.  
This menu is supported only in select printer models.  
Print a report containing information about copy shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about email shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about fax shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about FTP shortcuts.  
Print a list of profiles stored in the printer.  
Copy Shortcuts  
Email Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
Print Fonts  
Print a report of all the fonts available for the printer language currently set in  
the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
175  
Use  
To  
Print Directory  
Print a list of all the resources stored in an optional flash memory card or printer  
hard disk.  
Notes:  
Job Buffer Size must be set to 100%.  
Make sure the optional flash memory or printer hard disk is working and  
installed correctly.  
Asset Report  
Print a report containing asset information including the printer serial number  
and model name. The report contains text and UPC bar codes that can be scanned  
into an asset database.  
Network/Ports menu  
Active NIC menu  
Use  
To  
Active NIC  
Allow the printer to connect to a network.  
Auto  
Notes:  
[list of available network cards]  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only if an optional network adapter is installed.  
Standard Network or Network [x] menu  
Note: Only active ports appear in this menu. All inactive ports are omitted.  
Use  
To  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job requires  
it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
If PCL SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine incoming  
data and it uses the default printer language specified in the Setup menu.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job requires it,  
regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
If PS SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine incoming  
data and it uses the default printer language specified in the Setup menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
176  
Use  
To  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel, and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Network Buffer  
Auto  
Set the size of the network input buffer.  
Notes:  
3KB to [maximum size allowed]  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
The value can be changed in 1KB increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Network Buffer, disable or  
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and USB buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily store print jobs in the printer hard disk before printing. This menu only  
appears when a formatted disk is installed.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Auto  
Off is the factory default setting.  
On buffers print jobs on the printer hard disk.  
Auto buffers print jobs only when the printer is busy processing data from  
another input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel, and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Mac Binary PS  
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
Off filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
Standard Network Setup OR  
Network [x] Setup  
Show and set the printer network settings.  
Note: The Wireless menu appears only when the printer is connected to a wireless  
network.  
Reports  
Network Card  
TCP/IP  
IPv6  
Wireless  
AppleTalk  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
177  
Reports menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Reports  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Reports  
Use  
To  
Print Setup Page Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such as the TCP/IP address.  
Network Card menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Network Card  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Network Card  
Use  
To  
View Card Status  
Connected  
View the connection status of the wireless network adapter.  
Disconnected  
View Card Speed  
View the speed of an active wireless network adapter.  
View the network addresses.  
Network Address  
UAA  
LAA  
Job Timeout  
Set the amount of time it takes for a network print job to be canceled.  
0, 10–225 seconds  
Notes:  
“90 seconds” is the factory default setting.  
A setting value of 0 disables the timeout.  
If a value between 1 and 9 is selected, then Invalidappears on the  
display, and the value is not saved.  
Banner Page  
Allow the printer to print a banner page.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
TCP/IP menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > TCP/IP  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > TCP/IP  
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers attached to print servers.  
Use  
To  
Set Hostname  
Set the current TCP/IP host name.  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
178  
Use  
To  
IP Address  
View or change the current TCP/IP address.  
Note: Manually setting the IP address sets the Enable DHCP and Enable Auto IP  
settings to Off. It also sets Enable BOOTP and Enable RARP to Off on systems that  
support BOOTP and RARP.  
Netmask  
Gateway  
View or change the current TCP/IP netmask.  
View or change the current TCP/IP gateway.  
Enable DHCP  
Specify the DHCP address and parameter assignment.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable RARP  
Specify the RARP address assignment setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Enable BOOTP  
Specify the BOOTP address assignment setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable AutoIP  
Specify the Zero Configuration Networking setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable FTP/TFTP  
Enable the built-in FTP server, which lets you send files to the printer using File Transfer  
Protocol.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable HTTP Server  
Enable the built-in Web server (Embedded Web Server). When enabled, the printer  
can be monitored and managed remotely using a Web browser.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
WINS Server Address  
View or change the current WINS server address.  
Enable DDNS  
View or change the current DDNS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable mDNS  
View or change the current mDNS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
DNS Server Address  
View or change the current DNS server address.  
View or change the backup DNS server addresses.  
Backup DNS Server Address  
Backup DNS Server Address 2  
Backup DNS Server Address 3  
Enable HTTPS  
View or change the current HTTPS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
179  
IPv6 menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > IPv6  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > IPv6  
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.  
Use  
To  
Enable IPv6  
Enable IPv6 in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Auto Configuration  
Specify whether or not the wireless network adapter accepts the  
automatic IPv6 address configuration entries provided by a router.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
View Hostname  
View Address  
Set the host name.  
Note: These settings can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
View Router Address  
Enable DHCPv6  
Enable DHCPv6 in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Wireless menu  
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to a wireless network or printer models that have a wireless  
network adapter.  
To access the menu, navigate to:  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless  
Use  
To  
WiFi Protected Setup  
Start Push Button Method  
Start PIN Method  
Establish a wireless network and enable network security.  
Notes:  
Start Push Button Method connects the printer to a wireless  
network when buttons on both the printer and the access point  
(wireless router) are pressed within a given period of time.  
Start PIN Method connects the printer to a wireless network when  
a PIN on the printer is entered into the wireless settings of the  
access point.  
Enable/Disable WPS Autodetection  
Automatically detect the connection method that an access point with  
WPS uses—Start Push Button Method or Start PIN Method.  
Enable  
Disable  
Note: Disable is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
180  
Use  
To  
Network Mode  
BSS Type  
Specify the network mode.  
Notes:  
Infrastructure  
Ad hoc  
Infrastructure is the factory default setting. This lets the printer  
access a network using an access point.  
Ad hoc configures wireless connection directly between the printer  
and a computer.  
Compatibility  
802.11b/g  
Specify the wireless standard for the wireless network.  
Note: 802.11b/g/n is the factory default setting.  
802.11b/g/n  
Choose Network  
Select an available network for the printer to use.  
View the quality of the wireless connection.  
View Signal Quality  
View Security Mode  
View the encryption method for the wireless network.  
AppleTalk menu  
Note: This menu appears only in printer models that are connected to an Ethernet network or when an optional  
wireless network adapter is installed.  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > AppleTalk  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > AppleTalk  
Use  
To  
Activate  
Yes  
Enable or disable AppleTalk support.  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
No  
View Name  
View Address  
Set Zone  
Show the assigned AppleTalk name.  
Note: The AppleTalk name can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
Show the assigned AppleTalk address.  
Note: The AppleTalk address can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
Provide a list of AppleTalk zones available on the network.  
[list of zones available on the network]  
Note: The default zone for the network is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
181  
Standard USB menu  
Use  
To  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PostScript emulation if the PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default  
printer language specified in the Setup menu if the PS SmartSwitch is set to  
Off.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PCL emulation if the PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer  
language specified in the Setup menu if the PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting. Auto sets the printer to examine data,  
determine the format, and then process it appropriately.  
The printer automatically restarts when changing the setting from the printer  
control panel. The menu selection is then updated.  
USB Buffer  
Set the size of the USB input buffer.  
Disabled  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
3K to [maximum size allowed]  
Disabled turns off job buffering. Any jobs already buffered on the printer hard  
disk are printed before normal processing resumes.  
The USB buffer size value can be changed in 1-K increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the USB Buffer, disable or reduce the  
size of the parallel, serial, and network buffers.  
The printer automatically restarts when the setting is changed from the printer  
control panel. The menu selection is then updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
182  
Use  
To  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily store print jobs in the printer hard disk before printing.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
On buffers jobs on the printer hard disk.  
Auto buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from another  
input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Mac Binary PS  
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
Off filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
ENA Address  
Set the network address information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
ENA Netmask  
Set the netmask information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
ENA Gateway  
Set the gateway information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu is available only when the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
Parallel [x] menu  
Note: This menu appears only when an optional parallel card is installed.  
Use  
To  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PostScript emulation if PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer  
language specified in the Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
183  
Use  
To  
PS SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PCL emulation if PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer  
language specified in the Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Parallel Buffer  
Set the size of the parallel input buffer.  
Disabled  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
3K to [maximum size allowed]  
Disabled turns off job buffering. Any print jobs already buffered on the printer  
hard disk are printed before normal processing resumes.  
The parallel buffer size setting can be changed in 1KB increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Parallel Buffer, disable or reduce  
the size of the USB, serial, and network buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily store print jobs on the printer hard disk before printing.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
On buffers print jobs on the printer hard disk.  
Auto buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from another  
input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Advanced Status  
Enable bidirectional communication through the parallel port.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
Off disables parallel port negotiation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
184  
Use  
To  
Protocol  
Standard  
Fastbytes  
Specify the parallel port protocol.  
Notes:  
Fastbytes is the factory default setting. It provides compatibility with most  
existing parallel ports and is the recommended setting.  
Standard tries to resolve parallel port communication problems.  
Honor Init  
On  
Determine if the printer honors printer hardware initialization requests from the  
computer.  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The computer requests initialization by activating the Init signal from the  
parallel port. Many personal computers activate the Init signal each time the  
computer is turned on.  
Parallel Mode 2  
Determine if the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or trailing edge of a  
strobe.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.  
Notes:  
Mac Binary PS  
On  
Off  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Off filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
ENA Address  
Set the network address information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
ENA Netmask  
Set the netmask information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
ENA Gateway  
Set the gateway information for an external print server.  
yyy.yyy.yyy.yyy  
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
Serial [x] menu  
Note: This menu appears only when an optional serial card is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
185  
Use  
To  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PostScript emulation if PS SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer  
language specified in the Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the printer does not examine incoming data. The printer uses  
PCL emulation if PCL SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer  
language specified in the Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting. Auto sets the printer to examine data,  
determine the format, and then processes it appropriately.  
When set to On, the printer performs NPA processing. If the data is not in NPA  
format, it is rejected as bad data.  
When set to Off, the printer does not perform NPA processing.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Serial Buffer  
Set the size of the serial input buffer.  
Notes:  
Disabled  
Auto  
3K to [maximum size allowed]  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Disabled turns off job buffering. Any jobs already buffered on the disk are  
printed before normal processing is resumed.  
The serial buffer size setting can be changed in 1KB increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Serial Buffer, disable or reduce  
the size of the parallel, serial, and network buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
186  
Use  
To  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily store print jobs on the printer hard disk before printing.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. The printer does not buffer print jobs on the  
printer hard disk.  
Auto  
On buffers print jobs on the printer hard disk.  
Auto buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data from another  
input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Protocol  
Select the hardware and software handshaking settings for the serial port.  
DTR  
DTR/DSR  
Notes:  
DTR is the factory default setting.  
XON/XOFF  
XON/XOFF/DTR  
XONXOFF/DTRDSR  
DTR/DSR is a hardware handshaking setting.  
XON/XOFF is a software handshaking setting.  
XON/XOFF/DTR and XON/XOFF/DTR/DSR are combined hardware and  
software handshaking settings.  
Robust XON  
Determine whether the printer communicates availability to the computer.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies only to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to  
XON/XOFF.  
Baud  
Specify the rate at which data can be received through the serial port.  
1200  
2400  
Notes:  
9600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
138200, 172800, 230400, and 345600 baud rates are only displayed in the  
Standard Serial menu. These settings do not appear in the Serial Option 1,  
Serial Option 2, or Serial Option 3 menus.  
9600  
19200  
38400  
57600  
115200  
138200  
172800  
230400  
345600  
Data Bits  
Specify the number of data bits sent in each transmission frame.  
7
8
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
187  
Use  
To  
Parity  
Even  
Set the parity for serial input and output data frames.  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Odd  
None  
Ignore  
Honor DSR  
Determine whether the printer uses the DSR Signal.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
DSR is a handshaking signal used by most serial cables. The serial port uses  
DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data created by electrical  
noise in the serial cable. The electrical noise can cause stray characters to  
print. Set this to On to prevent stray characters from printing.  
SMTP Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Primary SMTP Gateway  
Primary SMTP Gateway Port  
Secondary SMTP Gateway  
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port  
Specify SMTP server gateway and port information.  
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.  
SMTP Timeout  
Specify the amount of time in seconds before the server stops trying to  
send an email.  
5–30  
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Reply Address  
Specify a reply address of up to 128 characters in the e-mail sent by the  
printer.  
Use SSL  
Set the printer to use SSL for increased security when connecting to the  
SMTP server.  
Disabled  
Negotiate  
Required  
Notes:  
Disabled is the factory default setting.  
When the Negotiate setting is used, the SMTP server determines if  
SSL will be used.  
SMTP Server Authentication  
No authentication required  
Login/Plain  
Specify the type of user authentication required for scanto email  
privileges.  
Note: “No authentication required” is the factory default setting.  
CRAMMD5  
DigestMD5  
NTLM  
Kerberos 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
188  
Use  
To  
DeviceInitiated Email  
None  
Specify what credentials will be used when communicating to the SMTP  
server. Some SMTP servers require credentials to send an e-mail.  
Use Device SMTP Credentials  
Notes:  
UserInitiated Email*  
None  
None is the factory default setting for DeviceInitiated Email and  
UserInitiated Email.  
Use Device SMTP Credentials  
Use Session User ID & Password  
Use Session Email address & Password  
Prompt User  
Device Userid and Device Password are used to log in to the SMTP  
server when Use Device SMTP Credentials is selected.  
Device Userid  
Device Password  
Kerberos 5 Realm  
NTLM Domain  
Security menu  
Edit Security Setups menu  
Use  
To  
Edit Backup Password  
Create a backup password.  
Use Backup Password  
Notes:  
Off  
On  
Password  
Off is the factory default setting for “Use Backup Password.”  
This menu item appears only if a backup password exists.  
Edit Building Blocks  
Internal Accounts  
NTLM  
Edit settings for Internal Accounts, NTLM, Simple Kerberos Setup, Kerberos Setup,  
Active Directory, LDAP, Password, and PIN.  
Simple Kerberos Setup  
Kerberos Setup  
Active Directory  
LDAP  
LDAP+GSSAPI  
Password  
PIN  
Edit Security Templates  
Add or edit a security template.  
[list of available templates]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
189  
Use  
To  
Edit Access Controls  
Administrative Menus  
Function Access  
Control access to printer menus, firmware updates, held jobs, and other access  
points.  
Management  
Solutions  
Cancel jobs at the Device  
Miscellaneous Security Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Login Restrictions  
Login failures  
Limit the number and time frames of failed login attempts from the printer control  
panel before all users are locked out.  
Failure time frame  
Lockout time  
Panel Login Timeout  
Remote Login Timeout  
Notes:  
“Login failures” specifies the number of failed login attempts before users are  
locked out. Settings range from 1 to 10 attempts is the factory default setting.  
“Failure time frame” specifies the time frame during which failed login  
attempts can be made before users are locked out. Settings range from 1 to 60  
minutes. 5 minutes is the factory default setting.  
“Lockout time” specifies how long users are locked out after exceeding the  
login failures limit. Settings range from 1 to 60 minutes. 5 minutes is the  
factory default setting. 1 indicates the printer does not impose a lockout time.  
“Panel Login Timeout” specifies how long the printer remains idle on the  
Home screen before automatically logging the user off. Settings range from 1  
to 900 seconds. 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
“Remote Login Timeout” specifies how long a remote interface remains idle  
before automatically logging the user off. Settings range from 1 to 120  
seconds. 10 minutes is the factory default setting.  
Security Reset Jumper  
Access controls=”No Security”  
No Effect  
Change the value of the security settings.  
Notes:  
Access controls=”No Security” retains all the security information that the user  
has defined. “No Security" is the factory default setting.  
Reset factory security defaults  
“No Effect” means the reset has no effect on the device’s security  
configuration.  
“Reset factory security defaults” deletes all security information that the user  
has defined, and assigns the factory default value to each setting in the  
Miscellaneous Security Settings section of both the panel and the Embedded  
Web Server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
190  
Use  
To  
LDAP Certificate Verification  
Allow the user to request a server certificate.  
Demand  
Try  
Allow  
Never  
Notes:  
“Demand” means a server certificate is requested. If a bad certificate is  
provided or if no certificate is provided, then the session is terminated  
immediately. “Demand” is the factory default setting.  
“Try” means a server certificate is requested. If no certificate is provided, then  
the session proceeds normally. If a bad certificate is provided, then the session  
is terminated immediately.  
“Allow” means a server certificate is requested. If no certificate is provided,  
then the session proceeds normally. If a bad certificate is provided, then it will  
be ignored, and then the session proceeds normally.  
“Never” means no server certificate is requested.  
Minimum PIN Length  
Limit the digit length of the PIN.  
1–16  
Note: 4 is the is the factory default setting.  
Confidential Print menu  
Use  
To  
Max Invalid PIN  
Set a limit on the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.  
Off  
2–10  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed.  
When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and PIN are deleted.  
Confidential Job Expiration Set a limit on how long the printer stores confidential print jobs.  
Off  
1 hour  
Notes:  
If the “Confidential Job Expiration” setting is changed while confidential print jobs  
reside in the printer memory or printer hard disk, then the expiration time for those  
print jobs does not change to the new default value.  
4 hours  
24 hours  
1 week  
If the printer is turned off, then all confidential jobs held in the printer memory are  
deleted.  
Repeat Job Expiration  
Set a limit on how long the printer stores print jobs.  
Off  
1 hour  
4 hours  
24 hours  
1 week  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
191  
Use  
To  
Verify Job Expiration  
Off  
Set a limit on how long the printer stores print jobs needing verification.  
1 hour  
4 hours  
24 hours  
1 week  
Reserve Job Expiration  
Set a limit on how long the printer stores print jobs for printing at a later time.  
Off  
1 hour  
4 hours  
24 hours  
1 week  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Disk Wiping menu  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data on the printer hard disk that are not currently in use by the file system. All  
permanent data on the printer hard disk are preserved, such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Note: This menu appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed.  
Use  
To  
Wiping Mode  
Specify the mode for disk wiping.  
Auto  
Automatic Method  
Single pass  
Mark all disk space used by a previous print job. This method does not permit the file  
system to reuse this space until it has been cleared.  
Multiple pass  
Notes:  
“Single pass” is the factory default setting.  
Only automatic wiping enables users to activate disk wiping without having to  
turn off the printer for an extended amount of time.  
Highly confidential information should be wiped using only the Multiple pass  
method.  
Security Audit Log menu  
Use  
To  
Export Log  
Let an authorized user export the audit log.  
Notes:  
To export the audit log from the printer control panel, a flash drive must be  
attached to the printer.  
The audit log can be downloaded from the Embedded Web Server and saved  
on a computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
192  
Use  
To  
Delete Log  
Yes  
Specify whether or not audit logs are deleted.  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
No  
Configure Log  
Specify how and whether or not audit logs are created.  
Enable Audit  
Notes:  
Yes  
Enable Audit determines if events are recorded in the secure audit log and  
No  
remote syslog. No is the factory default setting.  
Enable Remote Syslog  
Enable Remote Syslog determines if logs are sent to a remote server. No is the  
factory default setting.  
No  
Yes  
Remote Syslog Facility determines the value used to send logs to the remote  
syslog server. 4 is the factory default setting.  
Remote Syslog Facility  
0–23  
If the security audit log is activated, then the severity value of each event is  
recorded. 4 is the factory default setting.  
Severity of events to log  
0–7  
Set Date/Time menu  
Use  
To  
Current Date and Time  
Manually Set Date and Time  
View the current date and time settings for the printer.  
Enter the date and time.  
Note: Date/Time is set in YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS format.  
Time Zone  
Select the time zone.  
Note: GMT is the factory default setting.  
Automatically Observe DST  
Set the printer to use the applicable daylight saving time (DST) start and end times  
associated with the printer Time Zone setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting and uses the applicable Daylight Saving Time  
associated with the Time Zone setting.  
Custom Time Zone Setup  
DST Start Week  
DST Start Day  
Enable the user to set up the time zone.  
DST Start Month  
DST Start Time  
DST End Week  
DST End Day  
DST End Month  
DST End Time  
DST Offset  
Enable NTP  
Enable Network Time Protocol, which synchronizes the clocks of devices on a  
network.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
NTP Server  
View the NTP server address.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
193  
Use  
To  
Enable Authentication  
Change the authentication setting to On or Off.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Settings menu  
General Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Display Language  
English  
Set the language of the text appearing on the printer display.  
Note: Not all languages are available for all printers, and you may  
Francais  
need to install special hardware for those languages to appear.  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Espanol  
Dansk  
Norsk  
Nederlands  
Svenska  
Portuguese  
Suomi  
Russian  
Polski  
Greek  
Magyar  
Turkce  
Cesky  
Simplified Chinese  
Traditional Chinese  
Korean  
Japanese  
Eco-Mode  
Off  
Minimize the use of energy, paper, or specialty media.  
Notes:  
Energy  
Energy/Paper  
Paper  
Off is the factory default setting. This resets the printer to its  
factory default settings.  
The Energy setting minimizes the power used by the printer.  
Performance may be affected, but print quality is not.  
Energy/Paper minimizes the use of power and of paper and  
specialty media.  
Paper minimizes the amount of paper and specialty media  
needed for a print job. Performance may be affected, but  
print quality is not.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
194  
Use  
To  
ADF Loaded Beep  
Enabled  
Specify whether or not the ADF sounds a beep when paper is  
loaded.  
Disabled  
Note: Enabled is the factory default setting.  
ADF Multifeed Sensor  
Detect when the ADF picks more than one sheet of paper at once.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Quiet Mode  
Reduce the amount of noise produced by the printer.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. This supports the  
performance specifications for your printer.  
“On” configures the printer to produce as little noise as  
possible. This is best suited for printing text and line art.  
For optimal printing of colorrich documents, set Quiet Mode  
to Off.  
Selecting Photo from the printer driver may disable Quiet  
Mode and provide better print quality and full speed  
printing.  
Run Initial setup  
Set the printer to run the setup wizard.  
Yes  
No  
Notes:  
Yes is the factory default setting.  
After completing the setup wizard by selecting Done at the  
“Country select” screen, the default becomes No.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
195  
Use  
To  
Keyboard  
Keyboard Type  
English  
Specify a language and custom key information for the printer  
keyboard. The additional tabs enable access to accent marks and  
symbols from the keyboard.  
Francais  
Francais Canadien  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Espanol  
Greek  
Dansk  
Norsk  
Nederlands  
Svenska  
Suomi  
Portuguese  
Russian  
Polski  
Swiss German  
Swiss French  
Korean  
Magyar  
Turkce  
Cesky  
Simplified Chinese  
Traditional Chinese  
Japanese  
Custom Key [x]  
Paper Sizes  
US  
Specify the default paper measurement.  
Notes:  
Metric  
US is the factory default setting.  
The initial setting is determined by your country or region  
selection in the initial setup wizard.  
Changing this also changes the default setting for each input  
source in the Paper Size/Type menu.  
Scan to PC Port Range  
Specify a valid port range for printers behind a port blocking  
firewall. The valid ports are specified by two sets of numbers  
separated by a semicolon.  
[port range]  
Note: 9751:12000 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
196  
Use  
To  
Displayed Information  
Left side  
Specify what is displayed on the upper left and right corners of the  
home screen.  
For the Left side and Right side menus, select from the following  
options:  
Right side  
Custom Text [x]  
None  
IP Address  
Hostname  
Contact Name  
Location  
Date/Time  
mDNS/DDNS Service Name  
Zero Configuration Name  
Custom Text [x]  
Model Name  
Notes:  
IP Address is the factory default setting for Left side.  
Date/Time is the factory default setting for Right side.  
Displayed Information (continued)  
Customize the displayed information for Black Toner.  
Black Toner  
Select from the following options:  
When to display  
Do not display  
Display  
Message to Display  
Default  
Alternate  
Default  
[text entry]  
Alternate  
[text entry]  
Notes:  
“Do not display” is the factory default setting for When to  
display.  
Default is the factory default setting for Message to Display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
197  
Use  
To  
Displayed Information (continued)  
Waste Toner Bottle  
Paper Jam  
Customize the displayed information for Waste Toner Bottle, Paper  
Jam, Load Paper, and Service Errors menus.  
Select from the following options:  
Display  
Load Paper  
Yes  
Service Errors  
No  
Message to display  
Default  
Alternate  
Default  
[text entry]  
Alternate  
[text entry]  
Notes:  
No is the factory default setting for Display.  
Default is the factory default setting for Message to Display.  
Home screen customization  
Change Language  
Copy  
Change the icons that appear on the home screen.  
For each icon, select from the following options:  
Display  
Copy Shortcuts  
Fax  
Fax Shortcuts  
Email  
Email Shortcuts  
FTP  
FTP Shortcuts  
Search Held Jobs  
Held Jobs  
Do Not display  
Notes:  
Display is the factory default setting for Copy, Fax, Email,  
FTP, Search Held Jobs, Held jobs, USB Drive, and Forms and  
Favorites menus.  
“Do not display” is the factory default setting for Change  
language, Copy shortcuts, Fax Shortcuts, Email Shortcuts,  
FTP Shortcuts, Profiles and Solutions, Bookmarks, and Jobs  
by user menus.  
USB Drive  
Profiles and Solutions  
Bookmarks  
Jobs by user  
Forms and Favorites  
Date Format  
MMDDYYYY  
DDMMYYYY  
YYYYMMDD  
Format the printer date.  
Notes:  
MMDDYYYY is the U.S. factory default setting.  
DD-MM-YYYY is the International factory default setting.  
Time Format  
Format the printer time.  
12 hour A.M./P.M.  
24 hour clock  
Note: “12 hour A.M./P.M.” is the factory default setting.  
Screen Brightness  
Specify the brightness of the printer control panel screen.  
20–100  
Note: 100 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
198  
Use  
To  
One Page Copy  
Set copies from the scanner glass to only one page at a time.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Output Lighting  
Set the amount of light from the standard output bin.  
Normal/Standby Mode  
Notes:  
Off  
Dim is the factory default setting if Eco-Mode is set to Energy  
Dim  
Bright  
or Energy/Paper.  
Bright is the factory default setting if Eco-Mode is Off or set  
to Paper.  
Error Lighting  
Determine if indicator lights blink when the printer encounters  
errors.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Set the audio volume for the buttons.  
Notes:  
Audio Feedback  
Button Feedback  
On  
Off  
On is the factory default setting for Button Feedback.  
5 is the factory default setting for Volume.  
Volume  
1–10  
Tactile Touchscreen Feedback  
Provide touchscreen sensation feedback.  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
On  
Off  
Show Bookmarks  
Specify whether bookmarks are displayed from the Held Jobs area.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting. When Yes is selected,  
bookmarks appear in the Held Jobs area.  
Allow Background Removal  
Specify whether image background removal is allowed in copy, fax,  
email, FTP, or scantoUSB jobs.  
Note: On is the factory default setting. The background of the  
On  
Off  
image will be removed.  
Allow Custom Job Scans  
Scan multiple jobs to one file.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting. If On is selected, then the  
Allow Custom Job Scans setting can be enabled for specific jobs.  
Scanner Jam Recovery  
Job level  
Specify how a scanned job should be reloaded if a paper jam occurs  
in the ADF.  
Page level  
Notes:  
Job level is the factory default setting.  
If Job level is selected, then the entire job must be rescanned  
if any pages jam.  
If Page level is selected, then rescan from the jammed page  
forward.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
199  
Use  
To  
Web Page Refresh Rate  
Specify the number of seconds between Embedded Web Server  
refreshes.  
30–300  
Note: 120 is the factory default setting.  
Contact Name  
Location  
Specify a contact name for the printer.  
Note: The contact name is stored on the Embedded Web Server.  
Specify the location of the printer.  
Note: The location is stored on the Embedded Web Server.  
Alarms  
Set an alarm to sound when the printer requires operator  
intervention.  
Alarm Control  
Cartridge Alarm  
Staple Alarm  
Hole Punch Alarm  
For each alarm type, select from the following options:  
Off  
Single  
Continuous  
Notes:  
Single is the factory default setting for Alarm Control. Single  
sounds three quick beeps.  
Off is the factory default setting for Cartridge Alarm, Staple  
Alarm, and Hole Punch Alarm. Off means no alarm will  
sound.  
Continuous repeats three beeps every 10 seconds.  
Timeouts  
Standby Mode  
Disabled  
Specify the number of minutes of inactivity before the printer  
enters a lower power state.  
Note: 15 is the factory default setting.  
1–240  
Timeouts  
Sleep Mode  
Disabled  
1180  
Set the amount of time in minutes the printer waits after a job is  
printed before it goes into a reduced power state.  
Notes:  
30 is the factory default setting.  
Lower settings conserve more energy, but may require  
longer warmup times.  
Select the lowest setting if the printer shares an electrical  
circuit with room lighting or you notice lights flickering in the  
room.  
Select a high setting if the printer is in constant use. Under  
most circumstances, this keeps the printer ready to print  
with minimum warmup time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
200  
Use  
To  
Timeouts  
Hibernate Timeout  
Disabled  
1–3 hr  
Set the printer to operate at a low power state.  
Note: Disabled is the factory default setting in all countries.  
6 hr  
1–3 days  
1–2 weeks  
1 month  
Hibernate Timeout on Connection  
Hibernate  
Set the printer to Hibernate Timeout even when there is an active  
Ethernet and/or a phone connection.  
Do Not Hibernate  
Note: Do Not Hibernate is the factory default setting.  
Timeouts  
Set the amount of time in seconds the printer waits before  
returning the printer display to a Ready state.  
Screen Timeout  
15–300  
Note: 30 is the factory default setting.  
Timeouts  
Set the printer to continue a specified job without returning to the  
homescreen when the screen timeout timer expires.  
Prolong Screen Timeout  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Timeouts  
Print Timeout  
Disabled  
Set the amount of time in seconds the printer waits to receive an  
endofjob message before canceling the remainder of the print  
job.  
1–255  
Notes:  
90 is the factory default setting.  
When the timer expires, any partially printed page still in the  
printer is printed, and then the printer checks to see if any  
new print jobs are waiting.  
Print Timeout is available only when using PCL emulation.  
This has no effect on PostScript emulation print jobs.  
Timeouts  
Wait Timeout  
Disabled  
Set the amount of time in seconds the printer waits for additional  
data before canceling a print job.  
Notes:  
15–65535  
40 is the factory default setting.  
Wait Timeout is available only when the printer is using  
PostScript emulation. This has no effect on PCL emulation  
print jobs.  
Timeouts  
Set the amount of time the printer waits for user intervention  
before it holds jobs that require unavailable resources and  
continues to print other jobs in the print queue.  
Job Hold Timeout  
5–255  
Notes:  
30 is the factory default setting.  
This menu appears only when a printer hard disk is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
201  
Use  
To  
Error Recovery  
Auto Reboot  
Automatically reboot the printer.  
Note: “Reboot when idle” is the factory default setting.  
Reboot when idle  
Reboot always  
Reboot never  
Error Recovery  
Max Auto Reboots  
120  
Determine the number of automatic reboots the printer can  
perform.  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Print Recovery  
Auto Continue  
Disabled  
Let the printer automatically continue printing from certain offline  
situations when not resolved within the specified time period.  
Note: Disabled is the factory default setting.  
5–255  
Print Recovery  
Specify whether the printer reprints jammed pages.  
Jam Recovery  
Notes:  
On  
Auto is the factory default setting. The printer reprints  
jammed pages unless the memory required to hold the  
pages is needed for other printer tasks.  
Off  
Auto  
On sets the printer to always reprint jammed pages.  
Off sets the printer to never reprint jammed pages.  
Print Recovery  
Set the printer to automatically check for jammed paper.  
Jam Assist  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Off  
Print Recovery  
Page Protect  
Off  
Let the printer successfully print a page that may not have printed  
otherwise.  
Notes:  
On  
Off is the factory default setting. This prints a partial page  
when there is not enough memory to print the whole page.  
On sets the printer to process the whole page so that the  
entire page prints.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
202  
Use  
To  
Press Sleep Button  
Do Nothing  
Sleep  
Determine how the printer responds when pressing the Sleep  
button when the printer is idle.  
Notes:  
Hibernate  
Sleep is the factory default setting.  
Sleep or Hibernate sets the printer to operate at a lower  
power configuration.  
If the printer is in Sleep Mode, then the display appears off  
and the Sleep button turns amber.  
Touch anywhere on the display or press a button on the  
printer control panel to exit Sleep Mode.  
If the printer is in Hibernate mode, then the display is  
completely off and the Sleep button turns amber and is  
blinking.  
Press and Hold Sleep Button  
Do Nothing  
Determine how the printer responds when pressing the Sleep  
button when the printer is idle.  
Sleep  
Notes:  
Hibernate  
Do Nothing is the factory default setting.  
Sleep or Hibernate sets the printer to operate at a lower  
power configuration.  
If the printer is in Sleep Mode, then the display appears off  
and the Sleep button turns amber.  
Press and hold the Sleep button for 3 seconds or longer to  
enter Hibernate mode.  
Touch anywhere on the display or press a button on the  
printer control panel to exit Sleep Mode.  
Factory Defaults  
Do Not Restore  
Restore Now  
Restore the printer settings to the factory default settings.  
Notes:  
Do Not Restore is the factory default setting. This keeps the  
userdefined settings.  
Restore Now returns all printer settings to the factory  
default settings except Network/Ports menu settings. All  
downloads stored in RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in  
flash memory or on a printer hard disk are not affected.  
Copy Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
203  
Use  
To  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Sides (Duplex)  
Specify whether an original document is twosided (duplex) or onesided, and then to  
specify whether the copy should be twosided or onesided.  
1 sided to 1 sided  
1 sided to 2 sided  
2 sided to 1 sided  
2 sided to 2 sided  
Notes:  
1 sided to 1 sided—The original document has print on one side and the copy  
will also have print on one side.  
1 sided to 2 sided—The original document has print on one side, while the  
copy will have print on both sides.  
2 sided to 1 sided—The original document has print on both sides, while the  
copy will have print on just one side.  
2 sided to 2 sided—The original document has print on both sides, and the  
copy will also have print on both sides.  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Copy two or four sheets of a document on one page.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
2up Portrait  
4up Portrait  
2up Landscape  
4up Landscape  
Print Page Borders  
Specify whether or not a border is printed.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Collate  
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies.  
1,1,1 2,2,2  
1,2,3 1,2,3  
Note: “1,2,3 1,2,3” is the factory default setting.  
Punch  
Off  
Specify the type of hole punch finishing to be used in a print or copy job.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
2 holes  
3 holes  
4 holes  
Staple  
Off  
Enable or disable the staple finisher.  
Notes:  
On  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a staple finisher is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
204  
Use  
To  
Offset Stacker  
None  
Offset pages at certain instances.  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
None is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when an offset stacker or a staple finisher is  
installed.  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Difficult Media Letter  
Difficult Media A5  
Difficult Media Legal  
Difficult Media A4  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
ID Card  
Copy To Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for copy jobs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Size Match  
Manual Feeder  
Transparency Separators  
Place a sheet of paper between transparencies.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Place a sheet of paper between pages, copies, or jobs.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Separator Sheet Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the separator sheet source.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
205  
Use  
To  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the print for the copy job.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify the bin to be used for the copy job.  
Notes:  
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Bin [x] appears only when at least one optional bin is installed.  
Number of Copies  
Specify the number of copies for the copy job.  
1–999  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Header/Footer  
[Location]  
Specify header and footer information and its location on the page.  
For the location, select from the following options:  
Off  
Top left  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Custom text  
Print on  
Top middle  
Top right  
Bottom left  
Bottom middle  
Bottom right  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Custom text  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for the location.  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for “Print on.”  
Overlay  
Confidential  
Copy  
Specify the overlay text printed on each page of the copy job.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Draft  
Urgent  
Custom  
Off  
Custom Overlay  
Specify the custom overlay text.  
Note: A maximum of 64 characters is allowed.  
Allow priority copies  
Allow interruption of a print job to copy a page or document.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Custom Job scanning  
Copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single copy job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Save custom copy settings as shortcuts.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
206  
Use  
To  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Automatically center the content on the page.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast used for the copy job.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness of a copy.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Sample Copy  
Create a sample copy of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Fax Settings menu  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) menu  
Analog Fax Setup mode sends the fax job through a telephone line.  
General Fax Settings  
Use  
To  
Fax Name  
Fax Number  
Specify the name of the fax in the printer.  
Specify the number assigned to the fax.  
Specify how the fax is identified.  
Fax ID  
Fax Name  
Fax Number  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
207  
Use  
To  
Enable Manual Fax  
Set the printer to fax manually, which requires a line splitter and a telephone handset.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Use a regular telephone to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a fax  
number.  
Touch # 0 on the numeric keypad to go directly to the Manual Fax function.  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Memory Use  
All receive  
Mostly receive  
Equal  
Define the allocation of non-volatile memory between sending and receiving fax jobs.  
Notes:  
“Equal” is the factory default setting. Equal splits the memory for sending and  
receiving fax jobs into equal amounts.  
Mostly send  
All send  
“Mostly send” specifies that most of the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
“All send” specifies that all the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
“All receive” specifies that all the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
“Mostly receive” specifies that most of the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
Cancel Faxes  
Allow  
Specify whether or not the printer cancels fax jobs.  
Note: Allow is the factory default setting.  
Don't Allow  
Caller ID  
Off  
Specify the type of caller ID being used.  
Primary  
Alternate  
Fax number masking  
Off  
Specify the direction from where digits are masked in an outgoing fax number.  
Notes:  
From left  
From right  
The number of characters masked is determined by the “Digits to mask”  
setting.  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Digits to Mask  
Specify the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number.  
0–58  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
208  
Use  
To  
Fax Cover Page  
Configure the fax cover page.  
Fax Cover Page  
Note: “Off by default” is the factory default setting for all Fax Cover Page options.  
Off by default  
On by default  
Never use  
Always use  
Include to Field  
On  
Off  
Include from Field  
On  
Off  
From  
Include Message Field  
On  
Off  
Message  
Include Logo  
On  
Off  
Include Footer [x]  
On  
Off  
Footer [x]  
Fax Send Settings  
Use  
To  
Resolution  
Specify quality in dots per inch (dpi). A higher resolution gives better print quality, but  
increases the fax transmission time for outgoing faxes.  
Standard  
Fine 200 dpi  
Note: Standard is the factory default setting.  
Super Fine 300 dpi  
Ultra Fine 600 dpi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
209  
Use  
To  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Note: Mixed Sizes is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
Legal  
default setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify how text and graphics are oriented on a page.  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Dial Prefix  
Enter a dialing prefix, such as 99. A numeric entry field is provided.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
210  
Use  
To  
Dialing Prefix Rules  
Establish a dialing prefix rule.  
Prefix Rule [x]  
Automatic Redial  
Specify the number of times the printer tries to send the fax to a specified number.  
0–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Redial frequency  
Specify the number of minutes between redials.  
1–200  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Behind a PABX  
Enable or disable switchboard blind dialing without a dial tone.  
Yes  
No  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
Enable ECM  
Enable or disable Error Correction Mode for fax jobs.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable Fax Scans  
Fax files that are scanned at the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Driver to fax  
Allow the printer driver to send fax jobs.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Save fax numbers as shortcuts in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Dial Mode  
Tone  
Specify the dialing sound, either as a tone or a pulse.  
Note: Tone is the factory default setting.  
Pulse  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specify the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are sent.  
Note: 33600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Custom Job scanning  
Scan a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single file.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Scan Preview  
Specify whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast in the scanned image.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
211  
Use  
To  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify if the original document is scanned edge-toedge prior to faxing.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the sharpness of a fax.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Temperature  
Specify “warm” or “cool” outputs. "Cool” values generate a bluer output than the  
default while “warm” values generate a redder output than the default.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Fax Receive Settings  
Use  
To  
Enable Fax Receive  
Allow the printer to receive fax jobs.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Fax Job Waiting  
None  
Remove fax jobs from the print queue when the job requires specific unavailable  
resources.  
Toner  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Toner and Supplies  
Rings to Answer  
Specify the number of rings before answering an incoming fax job.  
1–25  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Reduction  
Scale an incoming fax job so that it fits the size of the paper loaded in the designated  
fax source.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Paper Source  
Auto  
Specify the paper source for printing incoming fax jobs.  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Tray [x]  
MultiPurpose Feeder  
Sides (Duplex)  
Enable twosided (duplex) printing for incoming fax jobs.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
212  
Use  
To  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Enable the printer to include separator sheets for incoming fax jobs.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Before Job  
After Job  
Separator Sheet Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify where the printer picks the separator sheet.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify a bin for received faxes.  
Note: Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Fax Footer  
Print the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received fax.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specify the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are received.  
Note: 33600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Fax Forwarding  
Print  
Enable forwarding of received faxes to another recipient.  
Note: Print is the factory default setting.  
Print and Forward  
Forward  
Forward to  
Fax  
Specify the type of recipient to which faxes will be forwarded.  
Notes:  
Email  
FTP  
LDSS  
Fax is the factory default setting.  
This menu is available only from the printer Embedded Web Server.  
eSF  
Forward to Shortcut  
Enter the shortcut number which matches the recipient type (Fax, E-mail, FTP, LDSS,  
or eSF).  
Block No Name Fax  
Enable blocking of incoming faxes sent from devices with no station ID or fax ID  
specified.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Banned Fax List  
Enable the list of blocked fax numbers stored in the printer.  
Holding Faxes  
Held Fax Mode  
Off  
Enable fax holding all of the time or according to set schedule.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Always On  
Manual  
Scheduled  
Fax Holding Schedule  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
213  
Use  
To  
Punch  
Off  
Specify whether prints are punched.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
On  
Staple  
Off  
Specify whether prints are stapled.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
1 staple  
Offset Stacker  
None  
Offset pages at certain instances.  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
None is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when an offset stacker or a staple finisher is  
installed.  
Fax Log Settings  
Use  
To  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Enable printing of a transmission log after each fax job.  
Note: Print log is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Receive Error Log  
Print Never  
Enable printing of a receive error log following a receive error.  
Note: Print Never is the factory default setting.  
Print on Error  
Auto Print Logs  
Enable automatic printing of fax logs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
Logs print after every 200 fax jobs.  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the source of the paper used for printing logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Logs Display  
Specify whether printed logs display the dialed number or the station name or fax  
name returned.  
Remote Station Name  
Dialed Number  
Note: Remote Station Name is the factory default setting.  
Enable Job Log  
Enable access to the Fax Job log.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable Call Log  
Enable access to the Fax Call log.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify the bin where fax logs are printed.  
Note: Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
214  
Speaker Settings  
Use  
To  
Speaker Mode  
Always Off  
Specify the mode of the speaker.  
Notes:  
On until Connected  
Always On  
“On until Connected” is the factory default setting. A sound is issued until the  
fax connection is made.  
Always On turns the speaker on.  
Always Off turns the speaker off.  
Speaker Volume  
Control the volume setting.  
High  
Low  
Note: High is the factory default setting.  
Ringer Volume  
Control the fax speaker ringer volume.  
Off  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Answer On  
Use  
To  
All Rings  
Specify ring patterns when the printer is answering calls.  
Single Ring Only  
Note: All Rings is the factory default setting.  
Double Ring Only  
Triple Ring Only  
Single or Double Rings Only  
Single or Triple Rings Only  
Double or Triple Rings Only  
Email Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Email Server Setup  
Subject  
Specify email server information.  
Notes:  
Message  
File Name  
The subject field has a limitation of 255 characters.  
The message field has a limitation of 512 characters.  
Email Server Setup  
Send me a copy  
Never appears  
On by default  
Off by default  
Always On  
Send a copy of the e-mail to the sender.  
Note: “Never appears” is the factory default setting.  
Email Server Setup  
Max Email size  
0–65535 KB  
Specify the maximum e-mail size in kilobytes (KB).  
Note: E-mails bigger than the specified maximum size are not sent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
215  
Use  
To  
Email Server Setup  
Send a message when an e-mail is bigger than the configured size limit.  
Size Error Message  
Email Server Setup  
Specify a domain name, such as a company domain name, and then limits email  
destinations only to that domain name.  
Limit destinations  
Notes:  
E-mail can be sent only to the specified domain.  
The limit is one domain.  
Email Server Setup  
Web Link Setup  
Server  
Define the email server path name; for example: /directory/path.  
Note: The characters * : ? < > |are invalid entries for a path name.  
Login  
Password  
Path  
File Name  
Web Link  
Format  
Specify the format of the scanned file.  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
PDF Version  
1.2–1.6  
Set the version of the PDF file that will be scanned for emailing.  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
A–1a  
Content Type  
Graphics  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
216  
Use  
To  
Resolution  
75 dpi  
Specify the resolution of the scan in dots per inch.  
Note: “150 dpi” is the factory default setting.  
150 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
400 dpi  
600 dpi  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specify the orientation of the scanned image.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the document being scanned.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Difficult Media Letter  
Difficult Media A5  
Difficult Media Legal  
Difficult Media A4  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify how text and graphics are oriented on the page.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
217  
Use  
To  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Set the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and quality of the image.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size and quality of the image.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Text Default  
Set the quality of a text image in relation to file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo Default  
Set the quality of a text or photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  
image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Photo Default  
Set the quality of a photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 50 is the factory default setting.  
Email images sent as  
Attachment  
Specify how the images are sent.  
Note: Attachment is the factory default setting.  
Web Link  
Use MultiPage Tiff  
Choose between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a multiple-  
page scantoe-mail job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages, or  
multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specify whether or not the transmission log prints.  
Note: Print log is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for printing e-mail logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify the bin for FTP logs.  
Notes:  
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Bin [x] appears only when at least one optional bin is installed.  
Custom Job scanning  
Copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Scan Preview  
Specify whether or not a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
218  
Use  
To  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Save e-mail addresses as shortcuts.  
Notes:  
On  
Off  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the Save As Shortcut button does not appear on the e-mail  
Destination screen.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast of the output.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness on a scanned image.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Temperature  
Enable the user to specify “warm” or “cool” outputs. "Cool” values generate a bluer  
output than the default while “warm” values generate a redder output than the  
default.  
4 to 4  
Use cc:/bcc:  
Enable the use of the “cc:” and “bcc:” fields.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
FTP Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Format  
Specify the format of the file for FTP sending.  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF (.pdf)  
TIFF (.tif)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
219  
Use  
To  
PDF Version  
1.2–1.6  
Set the version level of the PDF file for FTP sending.  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
A–1a  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Resolution  
75 dpi  
Specify the quality of the scan in dots per inch (dpi).  
Note: “150 dpi” is the factory default setting.  
150 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
400 dpi  
600 dpi  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specify the page orientation of the scanned image.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
220  
Use  
To  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Difficult Media Letter  
Difficult Media A5  
Difficult Media Legal  
Difficult Media A4  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify the page orientation of text and graphics.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait and top edge for landscape ).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape ).  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Set the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the  
image.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Text Default  
Set the quality of the text in relation to the file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo Default  
Set the quality of a text/photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the  
image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
221  
Use  
To  
Photo Default  
Set the quality of a photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 50 is the factory default setting.  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provide a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scantoFTP job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages,  
or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specify whether the transmission log prints.  
Note: “Print log” is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify a paper source when printing FTP logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin [x]  
Specify the bin for FTP logs.  
Notes:  
Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Bin [x] only appears when at least one optional bin is installed.  
File Name  
Enter a base file name.  
Note: The limitation is 53 characters.  
Custom Job Scanning  
Copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single scan job.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Scan Preview  
Specify whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Enable shortcut creation for FTP addresses.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast of the output.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
222  
Use  
To  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness of a scanned image.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Temperature  
Enable the user to specify “warm” or “cool” outputs. "Cool” values generate a bluer  
output than the default while “warm” values generate a redder output than the  
default.  
4 to 4  
Flash Drive menu  
Scan Settings  
Use  
To  
Format  
Specify the format of the file to be sent through FTP.  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
PDF Version  
1.2–1.6  
A1a  
Set the version of the PDF file to be sent through FTP.  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
223  
Use  
To  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Resolution  
75 dpi  
Specify the resolution of the scan in dots per inch (dpi).  
Note: “150 dpi” is the factory default setting.  
150 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
400 dpi  
600 dpi  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specify the orientation of the scanned image.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
Legal  
default setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Difficult Media Letter  
Difficult Media A5  
Difficult Media Legal  
Difficult Media A4  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
224  
Use  
To  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify the page orientation of text and graphics.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Set the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and quality.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu applies to all scan functions.  
Text Default  
Set the quality of the text in relation to file size and the quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo Default  
Set the quality of a text/photo image in relation to file size and quality.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Photo Default  
Set the quality of a photo image in relation to file size and quality.  
5–90  
Note: 50 is the factory default setting.  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provide a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scan to FTP job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages,  
or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu applies to all scan functions.  
File Name  
Enter a base file name.  
Note: A maximum of 53 characters is allowed.  
Custom Job Scanning  
Copy a document containing mixed paper sizes in a single copy job.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Scan Preview  
Specify whether a preview appears on the display for scan jobs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
225  
Use  
To  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast of the scanned image.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness on a scanned image.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Temperature  
Enable the user to specify “warm” or “cool” outputs. "Cool” values generate a bluer  
output than the default while “warm” values generate a redder output than the  
default.  
4 to 4  
Print Settings  
Copies  
1–999  
Specify a default number of copies for each print job.  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Set a default paper source for all print jobs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Envelope  
Collate  
Stack the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies.  
1,1,1 2,2,2  
1,2,3 1,2,3  
Note: “1,2,3 1,2,3” is the factory default setting.  
Sides (Duplex)  
1 sided  
Specify whether prints are on one side or on both sides of the page.  
Note: 1 sided is the factory default setting.  
2 sided  
Staple  
Off  
Specify whether prints are stapled.  
Notes:  
On  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a staple finisher is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
226  
Offset Stacker  
Offset pages at certain instances.  
Notes:  
None is the factory default setting.  
None  
Between Copies  
Between Pages  
This menu item appears only when an offset stacker or a staple finisher is installed.  
Hole Punch  
Specify whether prints have punched holes.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple, hole punch finisher is installed.  
Hole Punch Mode  
2 holes  
Specify the number of holes to be made on the prints.  
Notes:  
3 holes  
4 holes  
“3 holes” is the U.S. factory default setting. “4 holes” is the international factory default  
setting.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple, hole punch finisher is installed.  
Duplex Binding  
Long Edge  
Define binding for duplexed pages in relation to the page orientation of the printed document.  
Notes:  
Short Edge  
Long Edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for portrait and top  
edge for landscape).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for portrait and  
left edge for landscape).  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Specify that multiplepage images be printed on one side of a paper.  
Notes:  
2Up  
Off is the factory default setting.  
3Up  
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side.  
4Up  
6Up  
9Up  
12Up  
16Up  
Paper Saver Ordering  
Horizontal  
Specify the positioning of multiplepage images.  
Notes:  
Reverse Horizontal  
Reverse Vertical  
Vertical  
Horizontal is the factory default setting.  
Positioning depends on the number of page images and whether they are in portrait or  
landscape orientation.  
Paper Saver Orientation Specify the orientation of a multiplepage document.  
Auto  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer chooses between portrait and landscape.  
Landscape  
Portrait  
Paper Saver Border  
Print a border on each page image.  
None  
Solid  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
227  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Specify whether blank separator sheets are inserted.  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if Collate is set to  
“1,2,3 1,2,3.” If Collate is set to “1,1,1 2,2,2,” then a blank page is inserted between  
each set of printed pages, such as after all page 1's and after all page 2's.  
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.  
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of the print job. This setting is  
useful when printing transparencies or when inserting blank pages in a document .  
Separator Sheet Source Specify the paper source for separator sheets.  
Tray [x]  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Blank Pages  
Specify whether blank pages are inserted in a print job.  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
Print Settings  
Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Printer Language  
PCL Emulation  
PS Emulation  
Set the default printer language.  
Notes:  
PS Emulation is the factory default printer language.  
Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent a  
software program from sending print jobs that use another  
printer language.  
Job Waiting  
Specify that print jobs be removed from the print queue if they  
require unavailable printer options or custom settings. They are  
storedin aseparateprintqueue,sootherjobsprintnormally. When  
the missing information or options are obtained, the stored jobs  
print.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu appears only when a printer hard disk is installed.  
This requirement ensures that stored jobs are not deleted if  
the printer loses power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
228  
Use  
To  
Print Area  
Normal  
Set the logical and physical printable area.  
Notes:  
Fit to Page  
Whole Page  
Normal is the factory default setting. When attempting to  
print data in the nonprintable area defined by the Normal  
setting, the printer clips the image at the boundary.  
Whole Page allows the image to be moved into the  
nonprintable area defined by the Normal setting. Whole  
Page only affects pages printed using a PCL 5e interpreter.  
This has no effect on pages printed using the PCL XL or  
PostScript interpreter.  
Download Target  
Set the storage location for downloads.  
RAM  
Flash  
Disk  
Notes:  
RAM is the factory default setting. Storing downloads in the  
RAM is temporary.  
Storing downloads in the flash memory or in a printer hard  
disk places them in permanent storage. Downloads remain in  
the flash memory or in the printer hard disk even when the  
printer is turned off.  
This menu appears only when a formatted, working flash  
drive or printer hard disk is installed.  
Resource Save  
Specify how the printer handles temporary downloads, such as  
fonts and macros stored in the RAM, when the printer receives a  
job that requires more memory than is available.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. This sets the printer to  
retain the downloads only until memory is needed.  
Downloads are deleted in order to process print jobs.  
On retains the downloads during language changes and  
printer resets. If the printer runs out of memory, then  
Memory Full [38]appears, and downloads are not  
deleted.  
Print All Order  
Alphabetical  
Oldest First  
Specify the order in which held and confidential jobs are printed  
when Print All is selected.  
Note: Alphabetical is the factory default setting. Print jobs always  
appear in alphabetical order on the printer control panel.  
Newest First  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
229  
Finishing menu  
Use  
To  
Sides (Duplex)  
1 sided  
Specify whether twosided (duplex) printing is set as the default for all print jobs.  
Notes:  
2 sided  
“1 sided” is the factory default setting.  
You can set twosided printing from the printer software.  
For Windows users:  
Click File > Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
For Macintosh users:  
Choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the Print dialog and popup  
menus.  
Duplex Binding  
Long Edge  
Define the way duplexed pages are bound and printed.  
Notes:  
Short Edge  
Long Edge is the factory default setting. This assumes binding along the long  
edge of the page (left edge for portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
Copies  
Specify the default number of copies for each print job.  
1–999  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Blank Pages  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specify whether blank pages are inserted in a print job.  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
Collate  
Stack the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies.  
1,1,1 2,2,2  
1,2,3 1,2,3  
Notes:  
“1,2,3 1,2,3” is the factory default setting.  
On stacks the print job in sequence.  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Specify whether blank separator sheets are inserted.  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
None is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if  
Collate is set to “1,2,3 1,2,3.” If Collate is set to “1,1,1 2,2,2,” then a blank  
page is inserted between each set of printed pages, such as after all page 1's  
and after all page 2's.  
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.  
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of a print job. This  
setting is useful when printing transparencies or when inserting blank pages in  
a document.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
230  
Use  
To  
Separator Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for separator sheets.  
Notes:  
Manual Feeder  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to "Cassette" for Manual Feeder to  
appear as a menu setting.  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Print multiplepage images on one side of a paper.  
Notes:  
2Up  
Off is the factory default setting.  
3Up  
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side.  
4Up  
6Up  
9Up  
12Up  
16Up  
Paper Saver Ordering  
Horizontal  
Specify the positioning of multiplepage images when using Paper Saver.  
Notes:  
Reverse Horizontal  
Reverse Vertical  
Vertical  
Horizontal is the factory default setting.  
Positioning depends on the number of page images and whether they are in  
portrait or landscape orientation.  
Paper Saver Orientation  
Auto  
Specify the orientation of a multiplepage document.  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer chooses between portrait and  
Landscape  
landscape.  
Portrait  
Paper Saver Border  
Print a border when using Paper Saver.  
None  
Solid  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Staple Job  
Off  
Specify whether printed output is stapled.  
Notes:  
On  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple finisher is installed.  
Run Stapler Test  
Print a report that confirms that the staple finisher is functioning properly.  
Note: This menu item appears only when a supported staple finisher is installed.  
Hole Punch  
Specify whether holes will be created on printed outputs for the purpose of collecting  
the sheets in a binder or folder.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple, hole punch finisher is  
installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
231  
Use  
To  
Hole Punch Mode  
2 holes  
Specify the number of holes to be created on printed outputs for the purpose of  
collecting the sheets in a binder or folder.  
3 holes  
Notes:  
4 holes  
“3 holes” is the U.S. factory default setting. “4 holes” is the international  
factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple, hole punch finisher is  
installed.  
Offset Pages  
None  
Offset pages at certain instances.  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
None is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies offsets each copy of a print job if Collate is set to “1,2,3 ‑  
1,2,3.” If Collate is set to “1,1,1 - 2,2,2,” then each set of printed pages are  
offset, such as all page 1's and all page 2's.  
Between Jobs sets the same offset position for the entire print job regardless  
of the number of copies printed.  
This menu item appears only when a supported staple finisher is installed.  
Quality menu  
Use  
To  
Print Resolution  
300 dpi  
Specify the printed output resolution in dots per inch.  
Note: 600 dpi is the factory default setting.  
600 dpi  
1200 dpi  
1200 Image Q  
2400 Image Q  
Pixel Boost  
Off  
Enablemore pixelsto print in clusters for clarity, in order to enhance images horizontally  
or vertically, or to enhance fonts.  
Fonts  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Horizontally  
Vertically  
Both directions  
Isolated  
Toner Darkness  
Lighten or darken the printed output.  
1–10  
Notes:  
8 is the factory default setting.  
Selecting a smaller number can help conserve toner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
232  
Use  
To  
Enhance Fine Lines  
Enable a print mode preferable for files such as architectural drawings, maps, electrical  
circuit diagrams, and flow charts.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
You can set this option from the printer software. For Windows users, click File >  
Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup. For Macintosh  
users, choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the Print dialog and  
popup menus.  
To set this option using the Embedded Web Server, type the network printer IP  
address in the Web browser address field.  
Gray Correction  
Automatically adjust the contrast enhancement applied to images.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Brightness  
Adjust the printed output either by lightening or darkening it. You can conserve toner  
by lightening the output.  
6 to 6  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
Adjust the contrast of printed objects.  
0–5  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Job Accounting menu  
Note: This menu item appears only when a formatted, working printer hard disk is installed. Make sure the printer  
hard disk is not read/writeor writeprotected.  
Use  
To  
Job Accounting Log  
Determine and set if the printer creates a log of the print jobs it receives.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Job Accounting Utilities  
Print and delete log files or export them to a flash drive.  
Accounting Log Frequency  
Weekly  
Determine and set how often a log file is created.  
Note: Monthly is the factory default setting.  
Monthly  
Log Action at End of Frequency  
None  
Determine and set how the printer responds when the frequency threshold expires.  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Email Current Log  
Email & Delete Current Log  
Post Current Log  
Post & Delete Current Log  
Disk Near Full Level  
Specify the maximum size of the log file before the printer executes the Disk Near  
Full Action.  
Off  
1–99  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
233  
Use  
To  
Disk Near Full Action  
None  
Determine and set how the printer responds when the printer hard disk is nearly full.  
Notes:  
Email Current Log  
Email & Delete Current Log  
Email & Delete Oldest Log  
Post Current Log  
None is the factory default setting.  
The value defined in Disk Near Full Level determines when this action is  
triggered.  
Post & Delete Current Log  
Post & Delete Oldest Log  
Delete Current Log  
Delete Oldest Log  
Delete All Logs  
Delete All But Current  
Disk Full Action  
Determine and set how the printer responds when disk usage reaches the maximum  
limit (100MB).  
None  
Email & Delete Current Log  
Email & Delete Oldest Log  
Post & Delete Current Log  
Post & Delete Oldest Log  
Delete Current Log  
Delete Oldest Log  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Delete All Logs  
Delete All But Current  
URL to Post Logs  
Determine and set where the printer posts job accounting logs.  
Specify the email address to which the printer sends job accounting logs.  
Specify the prefix you want for the log file name.  
Email Address to Send Logs  
Log File Prefix  
Note: The current host name defined in the TCP/IP menu is used as the default log  
file prefix.  
Utilities menu  
Use  
To  
Remove Held Jobs  
Confidential  
Held  
Delete confidential and held jobs from the printer hard disk.  
Notes:  
Selecting a setting affects only print jobs that are resident in the printer.  
Bookmarks, print jobs on flash drives, and other types of held jobs are not  
affected.  
Not Restored  
All  
Not Restored removes all Print and Hold jobs that are not restored from the  
printer hard disk or memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
234  
Use  
To  
Format Flash  
Format the flash memory.  
Yes  
No  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not turn off the printer while the flash memory is  
being formatted.  
Notes:  
Yes deletes all data stored in flash memory.  
No cancels the format request.  
Flash memory refers to the memory added by installing a flash memory card in  
the printer.  
The flash memory option card must not be read/writeor writeprotected.  
This menu item appears only when a nondefective flash memory card is  
installed.  
Delete Downloads on Disk  
Delete Now  
Delete downloads from the printer hard disk, including all held jobs, buffered jobs,  
and parked jobs.  
Do Not Delete  
Notes:  
Delete Now sets the printer to delete the downloads and allows the display to  
return to the originating screen after the deletion.  
Do Not Delete sets the printer display to return to the main Utilities menu for  
touchscreen printer models. When selected in nontouchscreen printer  
models, Do Not Delete sets the printer to return to the originating screen after  
the deletion.  
Activate Hex Trace  
Assist in isolating the source of a print job problem.  
Notes:  
When activated, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and  
character representation, and control codes are not executed.  
To exit or deactivate Hex Trace, turn off or reset the printer.  
Coverage Estimator  
Provide an estimate of the percentage coverage of toner on a page. The estimate is  
printed on a separate page at the end of each print job.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
XPS menu  
Use  
To  
Print Error Pages  
Print a page containing information on errors, including XML markup errors.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
PDF menu  
Use  
To  
Scale to Fit  
Scale page content to fit the selected paper size.  
Yes  
No  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
235  
Use  
To  
Annotations  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Print annotations in a PDF.  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
PostScript menu  
Use  
To  
Print PS Error  
Print a page containing the PostScript error.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Lock PS Startup Mode  
Disable the SysStart file.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Font Priority  
Resident  
Establish the font search order.  
Notes:  
Flash/Disk  
Resident is the factory default setting.  
This menu item is available only when a formatted flash memory option  
card or printer hard disk is installed and operating properly.  
Make sure the flash memory option or printer hard disk is not  
read/write, write, or passwordprotected.  
Job Buffer Size must not be set to 100%.  
PCL Emul menu  
Use  
To  
Font Source  
Resident  
Disk  
Specify the set of fonts used by the Font Name menu.  
Notes:  
“Resident” is the factory default setting. Resident shows the factory  
default set of fonts downloaded in the RAM.  
Download  
Flash  
All  
“Flash” and “Disk” settings show all fonts resident in that option.  
The flash option must be properly formatted and cannot be read/write,  
write, or passwordprotected.  
“Download” shows all the fonts downloaded in the RAM.  
“All” shows all fonts available to any option.  
Font Name  
Identify a specific font and the option where it is stored.  
Courier 10  
Note: Courier 10 is the factory default setting. Courier 10 shows the font  
name, font ID, and the storage location in the printer. The font source  
abbreviation is R for Resident, F for Flash, K for Disk, and D for Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
236  
Use  
To  
Symbol Set  
10U PC8  
Specify the symbol set for each font name.  
Notes:  
12U PC850  
10U PC8 is the US factory default setting. 12U PC850 is the international  
factory default setting.  
A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters, punctuation,  
and special symbols. Symbol sets support the different languages or  
specific programs such as math symbols for scientific text. Only the  
supported symbol sets are shown.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Point Size  
Change the point size for scalable typographic fonts.  
Notes:  
1.00–1008.00  
12 is the factory default setting.  
Point size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point  
equals approximately 0.014 inch.  
Point sizes can be increased or decreased in 0.25point increments.  
Specify the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.  
Notes:  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Pitch  
0.08–100  
10 is the factory default setting.  
Pitch refers to the number of fixedspace characters per inch (cpi).  
Pitch can be increased or decreased in 0.01cpi increments.  
For nonscalable monospaced fonts, the pitch appears on the display but it  
cannot be changed.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Orientation  
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on the page.  
Notes:  
Portrait  
Landscape  
Portrait is the factory default setting. Portrait prints text and graphics  
parallel to the short edge of the page.  
Landscape prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the page.  
Specify the number of lines that print on each page.  
Notes:  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Lines per Page  
1–255  
60 is the US factory default setting. 64 is the international default setting.  
The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on the  
Lines per Page, Paper Size, and Orientation settings. Select the Paper Size  
and Orientation you want before setting Lines per Page.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
A4 Width  
Set the printer to print on A4size paper.  
Notes:  
198 mm  
203 mm  
“198 mm” is the factory default setting.  
The 203mm setting sets the width of the page to allow printing of eighty  
10pitch characters.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
237  
Use  
To  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return (CR) after  
a line feed (LF) control command.  
Auto CR after LF  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a line feed (LF) after a  
carriage return (CR) control command.  
Auto LF after CR  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Tray Renumber  
Configure the printer to work with printer software or programs that use  
different source assignments for trays and feeders.  
Assign MP Feeder  
Off  
Notes:  
None  
0–199  
Assign Tray [x]  
“Off” is the factory default setting.  
“None” ignores the Select Paper Feed command. This option appears only  
when it is selected by the PCL 5 interpreter.  
Off  
None  
“0–199” allows a custom setting to be assigned.  
0–199  
Assign Manual Paper  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Assign Manual Env  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Tray Renumber  
View Factory Defaults  
MPF Default = 8  
T1 Default = 1  
Display the factory default setting assigned to each tray or feeder.  
T1 Default = 4  
T1 Default = 5  
T1 Default = 20  
T1 Default = 21  
Env Default = 6  
MPaper Default = 2  
MEnv Default = 3  
Tray Renumber  
Restore all tray and feeder assignments to the factory default settings.  
Restore Defaults  
Yes  
No  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
238  
HTML menu  
Use  
To  
Font Name  
Albertus MT  
Joanna MT  
Set the default font for HTML documents.  
Letter Gothic  
Lubalin Graph  
Marigold  
MonaLisa Recut  
Monaco  
New CenturySbk  
New York  
Optima  
Note: The Times font is used in HTML documents that do not  
specify a font.  
Antique Olive  
Apple Chancery  
Arial MT  
Avant Garde  
Bodoni  
Bookman  
Chicago  
Clarendon  
Cooper Black  
Copperplate  
Coronet  
Oxford  
Palatino  
StempelGaramond  
Taffy  
Courier  
Times  
Eurostile  
Garamond  
Geneva  
Gill Sans  
Goudy  
TimesNewRoman  
Univers  
Zapf Chancery  
NewSansMTCS  
NewSansMTCT  
New SansMTJA  
NewSansMTKO  
Helvetica  
Hoefler Text  
Intl CG Times  
Intl Courier  
Intl Univers  
Use  
Font Size  
1–255 pt  
To  
Set the default font size for HTML documents.  
Notes:  
12 pt is the factory default setting.  
Font size can be increased in 1point increments.  
Scale the default font for HTML documents.  
Notes:  
Scale  
1–400%  
100% is the factory default setting.  
Scaling can be increased in 1% increments.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Set the page orientation for HTML documents.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
239  
Use  
To  
Margin Size  
Set the page margin for HTML documents.  
8–255 mm  
Notes:  
19 mm is the factory default setting.  
Margin size can be increased in 1mm increments.  
Backgrounds  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specify whether to print backgrounds on HTML documents.  
Note: Print is the factory default setting.  
Image menu  
Use  
To  
Select the optimal paper size, scaling, and orientation.  
Auto Fit  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting. It overrides scaling and orientation settings  
Off  
for some images.  
Invert  
On  
Invert bitonal monochrome images.  
Notes:  
Off  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This setting does not apply to GIF or JPEG images.  
Scaling  
Scale the image to fit the selected paper size.  
Anchor Top Left  
Best Fit  
Anchor Center  
Fit Height/Width  
Fit Height  
Notes:  
Best Fit is the factory default setting.  
When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.  
Fit Width  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Set the image orientation.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Reverse Portrait  
Reverse Landscape  
Help menu  
The Help menu consists of a series of Help pages that are stored in the multifunction printer (MFP) as PDF files. They  
contain information about using the printer and performing various tasks, including copying, scanning, and faxing.  
English, French, German, and Spanish translations are stored in the printer. Other translations are available at  
Menu item  
Description  
Print All Guides  
Copy Guide  
Prints all the guides  
Provides information about making copies and changing settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
240  
Menu item  
Description  
Email Guide  
Provides information about sending emails using addresses, shortcut numbers, or  
the address book, and about changing settings  
Fax Guide  
FTP Guide  
Provides information about sending faxes using fax numbers, shortcut numbers,  
or the address book, and about changing settings  
Provides information about scanning documents directly to an FTP server using an  
FTP address, shortcut numbers, or the address book, and about changing settings  
Print Defects Guide  
Information Guide  
Supplies Guide  
Provides help in resolving repeating defects in copies or prints  
Provides help in locating additional information  
Provides part numbers for ordering supplies  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Saving money and the environment  
241  
Saving money and the environment  
Lexmark is committed to environmental sustainability and is continually improving its printers to reduce their impact  
on the environment. We design with the environment in mind, engineer our packaging to reduce materials, and provide  
collection and recycling programs. For more information, see:  
The Notices chapter  
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment  
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle  
By selecting certain printer settings or tasks, you may be able to reduce your printer's impact even further. This chapter  
outlines the settings and tasks that may yield a greater environmental benefit.  
Saving paper and toner  
Studies show that as much as 80% of the carbon footprint of a printer is related to paper usage. You can significantly  
reduce your carbon footprint by using recycled paper and the following printing suggestions, such as printing on both  
sides of the paper and printing multiple pages on one side of a single sheet of paper.  
To quickly save paper and energy using one printer setting, use Eco-Mode.  
Using recycled paper  
As an environmentally conscious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled office paper produced specifically for  
use in laser/LED printers. For more information on recycled papers that work well with your printer, see “Using recycled  
Conserving supplies  
Use both sides of the paper  
If your printer model supports duplex printing, then you can control whether print appears on one or two sides of the  
paper by selecting 2sided printing from the Print dialog or from the Lexmark Toolbar.  
Place multiple pages on one sheet of paper  
You can print up to 16 consecutive pages of a multiplepage document onto one side of a single sheet of paper by  
selecting a setting from the Multipage printing (NUp) section of the Print dialog screen.  
Check your first draft for accuracy  
Before printing or making multiple copies of a document:  
Use the preview feature, which you can select from the Print dialog or from the Lexmark Toolbar to see how the  
document will look like before you print it.  
Print one copy of the document to check its content and format for accuracy.  
Avoid paper jams  
Correctly set the paper type and size to avoid paper jams. For more information, see “Avoiding jams” on page 272.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Saving money and the environment  
242  
Saving energy  
Using EcoMode  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings > EcoMode > select a setting  
Use  
To  
Off  
Use the factory default settings for all settings associated with EcoMode. Off supports the performance  
specifications of the printer.  
Energy  
Reduce energy use, especially when the printer is idle.  
Printer engine motors do not start until it is ready to print. You may notice a short delay before the  
first page is printed.  
The printer enters Sleep mode after one minute of inactivity.  
Energy/Paper Use all the settings associated with Energy and Paper modes.  
Plain Paper  
Enable the automatic twosided (duplex) feature.  
Turn off print log features.  
3 Click Submit.  
Reducing printer noise  
Enable Quiet Mode to reduce printer noise.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Quiet Mode > select a setting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Saving money and the environment  
243  
Use  
To  
On  
Reduce printer noise.  
Notes:  
Print jobs are processed at a reduced speed.  
Printer engine motors do not start until a document  
is ready to print. There will be a short delay before  
the first page is printed.  
Off  
Use factory default settings.  
Note: This setting supports the performance  
specifications of the printer.  
3 Click Submit.  
Adjusting Sleep mode  
To save energy, decrease the number of minutes before the printer enters Sleep mode.  
Select from 1 to 120 minutes. The factory default setting is 30 minutes.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Timeouts.  
3 In the Sleep Mode field, enter the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters Sleep mode.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Timeouts > Sleep Mode  
2 In the Sleep Mode field, select the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters Sleep mode,  
and then touch Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Saving money and the environment  
244  
Using Hibernate mode  
Hibernate is an ultralowpower operating mode. When operating in Hibernate mode, the printer is essentially off, and  
all other systems and devices are turned off safely.  
Note: The Hibernate and Sleep modes can be scheduled.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Sleep Button Settings.  
3 From the “Press Sleep Button” or “Press and Hold Sleep Button” dropdown menu, select Hibernate.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings  
2 From the “Press Sleep Button” or “Press and Hold Sleep Button” menu, select Hibernate, and then touch Submit.  
Adjusting the brightness of the printer display  
To save energy, or if you are have trouble reading from the display, adjust the brightness of the display.  
Select from 20 to 100. The factory default setting is 100.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings.  
3 In the Screen Brightness field, enter the brightness percentage you want for the display.  
4 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Saving money and the environment  
245  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Screen Brightness  
2 In the Screen Brightness field, enter the brightness percentage you want for the display, and then touch Submit.  
Recycling  
Lexmark provides collection programs and environmentally progressive approaches to recycling. For more information,  
see:  
The Notices chapter  
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment  
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle  
Recycling Lexmark products  
To return Lexmark products for recycling:  
2 Find the product type you want to recycle, and then select your country or region from the list.  
3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Note: Printer supplies and hardware not listed in the Lexmark collection program may be recycled through your local  
recycling center. Contact your local recycling center to determine the items they accept.  
Recycling Lexmark packaging  
Lexmark continually strives tominimize packaging. Less packaging helps to ensure that Lexmark printers are transported  
in the most efficient and environmentally sensitive manner and that there is less packaging to dispose of. These  
efficiencies result in fewer greenhouse emissions, energy savings, and natural resource savings.  
Lexmark cartons are 100% recyclable where corrugated recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your area.  
The foam used in Lexmark packaging is recyclable where foam recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your  
area.  
When you return a cartridge to Lexmark, you can reuse the box that the cartridge came in. Lexmark will recycle the  
box.  
Returning Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling  
Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program diverts millions of Lexmark cartridges from landfills annually by making it both  
easy and free for Lexmark customers to return used cartridges to Lexmark for reuse or recycling. One hundred percent  
of the empty cartridges returned to Lexmark are either reused or demanufactured for recycling. Boxes used to return  
the cartridges are also recycled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Saving money and the environment  
246  
To return Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling, follow the instructions that came with your printer or cartridge and  
use the prepaid shipping label. You can also do the following:  
2 From the Toner Cartridges section, select your country or region.  
3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing the printer  
247  
Securing the printer  
Statement of Volatility  
Your printer contains various types of memory that can store device and network settings, and user data.  
Type of memory  
Description  
Volatile memory  
Your printer uses standard random access memory (RAM) to  
temporarily buffer user data during simple print jobs.  
Non-volatile memory  
Hard disk memory  
Your printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:  
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types are used to  
store the operating system, device settings, network  
information, bookmark settings, and embedded solutions.  
Some printers have a hard disk drive installed. The printer  
harddiskisdesignedfordevice-specificfunctionality.Thislets  
the device retain buffered user data from complex print jobs,  
as well as form data, and font data.  
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:  
The printer is being decommissioned.  
The printer hard disk is being replaced.  
The printer is being moved to a different department or location.  
The printer is being serviced by someone from outside your organization.  
The printer is being removed from your premises for service.  
The printer is being sold to another organization.  
Disposing of a printer hard disk  
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.  
In highsecurity environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data stored  
in the printer hard disk cannot be accessed when the printer—or its hard disk—is removed from your premises.  
Degaussing—Flushes the hard disk with a magnetic field that erases stored data  
Crushing—Physically compresses the hard disk to break component parts and render them unreadable  
Milling—Physically shreds the hard disk into small metal bits  
Note: Most data can be erased electronically, but the only way to guarantee that all data is completely erased is to  
physically destroy each hard disk where data is stored.  
Erasing volatile memory  
The volatile memory (RAM) installed in your printer requires a power source to retain information. To erase the buffered  
data, simply turn off the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Securing the printer  
248  
Erasing nonvolatile memory  
Erase individual settings, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions by following these  
steps:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress bar  
appears.  
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is fully  
turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display, instead of the standard home screen icons.  
3 Touch Wipe All Settings.  
The printer restarts several times during this process.  
Note: Wipe All Settings securely removes device settings, solutions, jobs, and passwords from the printer  
memory.  
4 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.  
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.  
Erasing printer hard disk memory  
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.  
Configuring Disk Wiping in the printer menus lets you remove residual confidential material left by print jobs by securely  
overwriting files that have been marked for deletion.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress bar  
appears.  
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is fully  
turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.  
3 Touch Wipe Disk, and then touch one of the following:  
Wipe disk (fast)—This lets you overwrite the disk with all zeroes in a single pass.  
Wipe disk (secure)—This lets you overwrite the disk with random bit patterns several times, followed by a  
verification pass. A secure overwrite is compliant with the DoD 5220.22M standard for securely erasing data  
from a printer hard disk. Highly confidential information should be wiped using this method.  
4 Touch Yes to proceed with disk wiping.  
Notes:  
A status bar indicates the progress of the disk wiping task.  
Disk wiping can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be unavailable  
for other user tasks.  
5 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.  
The printer undergoes a poweron reset, and then returns to normal operating mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Securing the printer  
249  
Configuring printer hard disk encryption  
Enable hard disk encryption to prevent loss of sensitive data in the event the printer or its hard disk is stolen.  
Note: Some printer models may not have a printer hard disk installed.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Security > Disk Encryption.  
Note: Disk Encryption appears in the Security Menu only when a formatted, nondefective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
3 From the Disk encryption menu, select Enable.  
Notes:  
Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.  
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be  
unavailable for other user tasks.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress bar  
appears.  
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is fully  
turned on, a list of functions appears on the printer display.  
3 Touch Disk Encryption > Enable.  
Note: Enabling disk encryption will erase the contents of the printer hard disk.  
4 Touch Yes to proceed with disk wiping.  
Notes:  
Do not turn off the printer during the encryption process. Doing so may result in loss of data.  
Disk encryption can take from several minutes to more than an hour, during which the printer will be  
unavailable for other user tasks.  
A status bar will indicate the progress of the disk wiping task. After the disk has been encrypted, the printer  
will return to the Enable/Disable screen.  
5 Touch Back > Exit Config Menu.  
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Securing the printer  
250  
Finding printer security information  
In high-security environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data stored  
in the printer cannot be accessed by unauthorized persons. For more information, visit the  
You can also see the Embedded Web Server Administrator’s Guide for additional information:  
1 Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then click SELECT YOUR PRODUCT.  
2 From the “Search by Product Category” section, navigate to Software and Solutions > Other Applications.  
3 Click the Manuals tab, and then select the Embedded Web Server Administrator’s Guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
251  
Maintaining the printer  
Warning—Potential Damage: Failure to maintain optimum printer performance, or to replace parts and supplies,  
may cause damage to your printer.  
Cleaning the printer parts  
Cleaning the printer  
Note: You may need to perform this task after every few months.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Damage to the printer caused by improper handling is not covered by the printer  
warranty.  
1 Make sure that the printer is turned off and unplugged from the electrical outlet.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer,  
unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before  
proceeding.  
2 Remove paper from the standard bin and multipurpose feeder.  
3 Remove any dust, lint, and pieces of paper around the printer using a soft brush or vacuum.  
4 Dampen a clean, lint-free cloth with water, and use it to wipe the outside of the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not use household cleaners or detergents to prevent damage to the exterior  
of the printer.  
5 Make sure all areas of the printer are dry before sending a new print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintaining the printer  
252  
Cleaning the scanner glass  
Clean the scanner glass if you encounter print quality problems, such as streaks on copied or scanned images.  
1 Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.  
2 Open the scanner cover.  
3 Remove the white underside of the scanner cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
253  
4 Open the bottom ADF door.  
2
1
5 Wipe the ADF scanner glass under the ADF door.  
6 Close the bottom ADF door.  
7 Place the white underside of the scanner cover on the scanner glass, and then close the scanner cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
254  
8 Wipe the areas shown, and then let them dry.  
4
3
1
2
1
2
3
4
White underside of the scanner cover  
Scanner glass  
ADF glass  
White underside of the ADF cover  
9 Close the scanner cover.  
Emptying the hole punch box  
1 Pull out the hole punch box.  
2 Empty the container.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
255  
3 Insert the emptied hole punch box back into the finisher until it clicks into place.  
Checking the status of parts and supplies  
A message appears on the display when a replacement supply item is needed or when maintenance is required.  
Checking the status of parts and supplies on the printer control panel  
From the home screen, touch Status/Supplies > View Supplies.  
Checking the status of parts and supplies from the Embedded Web Server  
Note: Make sure the computer and the printer are connected to the same network.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated  
by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Device Status > More Details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintaining the printer  
256  
Ordering supplies  
To order parts and supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark authorized  
supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com or contact  
the place where you purchased the printer.  
Note: All life estimates for printer supplies assume printing on letteror A4size plain paper.  
Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies  
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-party supplies  
or parts may affect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components. Use of third-party  
supplies or parts can affect warranty coverage. Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies or parts is not covered  
by the warranty. All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts, and may deliver  
unpredictable results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may  
damage your Lexmark printer or its associated components.  
Estimated number of remaining pages  
The estimated number of remaining pages is based on the recent printing history of the printer. Its accuracy may  
vary significantly and is dependent on many factors, such as actual document content, print quality settings, and  
other printer settings.  
The accuracy of the estimated number of remaining pages may decrease when the actual printing consumption is  
differentfromthehistorical printingconsumption. Considerthe variablelevel of accuracy beforepurchasing or replacing  
supplies based on the estimate. Until an adequate print history is obtained on the printer, the estimated cartridge yield is  
based on approximately 5% coverage per page.  
Ordering a toner cartridge  
Notes:  
The estimated cartridge yield is based on approximately 5% coverage per page.  
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may negatively affect actual yield.  
Item  
Return Program cartridge  
Extra High Yield Toner Cartridge  
24B6020  
Ordering a maintenance kit  
To identify the supported fuser type, view the label on the fuser. Do either of the following:  
Remove the toner cartridge and imaging unit. The two-digit fuser type code (such as 00 or 01) can be seen on the  
front of the fuser.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
Pull down the printer rear door. The two-digit fuser type code (such as 00 or 01) can be seen on the rear of the  
fuser.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Maintaining the printer  
257  
Notes:  
Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit.  
The separator roller, fuser, pick roller assembly, and transfer roller are all included in the maintenance kit and  
can be individually ordered and replaced if necessary.  
For more information on replacing the parts included in the maintenance kit, see the instruction sheet that  
came with each part.  
Lexmark Return Program fuser maintenance kit type  
Type  
Part number  
40X8420  
40X8421  
40X8422  
40X8423  
40X8424  
XM7100 Series Return Program fuser maintenance kit Type 00  
XM7100 Series Return Program fuser maintenance kit Type 01  
XM7100 Series Return Program fuser maintenance kit Type 02  
XM7100 Series Return Program fuser maintenance kit Type 03  
XM7100 Series Return Program fuser maintenance kit Type 04  
Lexmark regular fuser maintenance kit type  
Type  
Part number  
40X8425  
40X8426  
40X8427  
40X8428  
40X8429  
XM7100 Series regular fuser maintenance kit Type 05  
XM7100 Series regular fuser maintenance kit Type 06  
XM7100 Series regular fuser maintenance kit Type 07  
XM7100 Series regular fuser maintenance kit Type 08  
XM7100 Series regular fuser maintenance kit Type 09  
Lexmark roller kit  
Part number  
XM7100 Series roller kit  
40X7706  
Lexmark ADF maintenance kit  
Part number  
XM7100 Series ADF maintenance kit  
40X8431  
Ordering an imaging unit  
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may cause imaging unit parts to fail prior to exhaustion of  
toner.  
For more information on replacing the imaging unit, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.  
Part name  
Lexmark Return Program  
Imaging unit  
24B6025  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
258  
Ordering staple cartridges  
Part name  
Part number  
Staple cartridges  
25A0013  
Storing supplies  
Choose a cool, clean storage area for the printer supplies. Store supplies right side up in their original packing until you  
are ready to use them.  
Do not expose supplies to:  
Direct sunlight  
Temperatures above 35°C (95°F)  
High humidity above 80%  
Salty air  
Corrosive gases  
Heavy dust  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
259  
Replacing supplies  
Replacing the toner cartridge  
1 Lift the front cover, and then pull down the multipurpose feeder door.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
260  
2 Pull the cartridge out of the printer using the handle.  
3 Unpack the new toner cartridge, then remove the packing material, and then shake the cartridge to redistribute  
the toner.  
4 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the side rails  
inside the printer.  
Note: Make sure the cartridge is fully pushed in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
261  
Warning—Potential Damage: When replacing a toner cartridge, do not leave the imaging unit exposed to direct  
light for an extended period of time. Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
5 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.  
2
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
262  
Replacing the imaging unit  
1 Lift the front cover, and then pull down the multipurpose feeder door.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
263  
2 Pull out the toner cartridge from the printer using the handle.  
3 Lift the green handle, and then pull out the imaging unit from the printer.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
264  
4 Unpack the new imaging unit, and then shake it.  
5 Remove all packing material from the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may affect the print quality of  
future print jobs.  
6 Insert the imaging unit into the printer by aligning the arrows on the side rails of the imaging unit with the arrows  
on the side rails inside the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
265  
7 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the side rails  
inside the printer.  
8 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.  
2
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
266  
Replacing a staple cartridge  
1 Open the stapler door.  
1
2
2 Pull down the latch of the staple cartridge holder, and then pull the holder out of the finisher.  
3 Squeeze both sides of the empty staple case with your fingers, and then remove the staple case from the cartridge.  
1
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
267  
4 Insert the front side of the new staple case into the staple cartridge, and then push the rear side into the cartridge.  
2
1
5 Push the staple cartridge into the finisher until it clicks into place.  
6 Close the stapler door.  
Moving the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
Before moving the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
268  
If an optional tray is installed, then remove it from the printer. To remove the optional tray, slide the latch on the  
right side of the tray toward the front of the tray until it clicks into place.  
Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it.  
Make sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.  
Before setting up the printer, make sure there is adequate clearance around it.  
Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer  
warranty.  
Moving the printer to another location  
The printer and its hardware options can be safely moved to another location by following these precautions:  
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.  
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the hardware  
options.  
Keep the printer in an upright position.  
Avoid severe jarring movements.  
Shipping the printer  
When shipping the printer, use the original packaging or call the place of purchase for a relocation kit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the printer  
269  
Managing the printer  
Finding advanced networking and administrator information  
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced system  
support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software CD or the Embedded Web Server Administrator's Guide at  
Checking the virtual display  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Check the virtual display that appears in the top left corner of the screen.  
The virtual display works as an actual display would work on a printer control panel.  
Setting up email alerts  
Configure the printer to send you email alerts when the supplies are getting low or when the paper needs to be changed  
or added, or when there is a paper jam.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 From the Other Settings menu, click Email Alert Setup.  
4 Select the items you want to be notified on, and then type the email addresses.  
5 Click Submit.  
Note: For information on setting up the email server, contact your system support person.  
Viewing reports  
You can view some reports from the Embedded Web Server. These reports are useful for assessing the status of the  
printer, network, and supplies.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Managing the printer  
270  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Reports, and then click the type of report you want to view.  
Configuring supply notifications from the Embedded Web  
Server  
You can determine how you would like to be notified when supplies run nearly low, low, very low, or reach their  
endoflife by setting the selectable alerts.  
Notes:  
Selectable alerts can be set on the toner cartridge, imaging unit, and maintenance kit.  
All selectable alerts can be set for nearly low, low, and very low supply conditions. Not all selectable alerts can  
be set for the endoflife supply condition. Email selectable alert is available for all supply conditions.  
The percentage of estimated remaining supply that prompts the alert can be set on some supplies for some  
supply conditions.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Supply Notifications.  
3 From the dropdown menu for each supply, select one of the following notification options:  
Notification  
Off  
Description  
The normal printer behavior for all supplies occurs.  
Email Only  
The printer generates an email when the supply condition is reached. The status of the  
supply appears on the menus page and status page.  
Warning  
The printer displays the warning message and generates an email about the status of the  
supply. The printer does not stop when the supply condition is reached.  
Continuable Stop1  
Non Continuable Stop1,2  
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached, and the user needs  
to press a button to continue printing.  
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached. The supply must be  
replaced to continue printing.  
1 The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.  
2 The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.  
4 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Managing the printer  
271  
Restoring factory default settings  
If you want to keep a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before restoring  
the factory default settings. For more information, see “Printing a menu settings page” on page 64.  
If you want a more comprehensive method of restoring the printer factory default settings, then perform the Wipe All  
Settings option. For more information, see “Erasing nonvolatile memory” on page 248.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory default  
settings. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and network/port menu settings. All  
downloads stored in the RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in the flash memory or in a printer hard disk are not  
affected.  
From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Factory Defaults > Restore Now > Submit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
272  
Clearing jams  
Jam error messages appear on the printer display and include the area of the printer where the jam occurred. When  
there is more than one jam, the number of jammed pages is displayed.  
Avoiding jams  
Load paper properly  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
Correct loading of paper Incorrect loading of paper  
Do not remove a tray while the printer is printing.  
Do not load a tray while the printer is printing. Load it before printing, or wait for a prompt to load it.  
Do not load too much paper. Make sure the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Clearing jams  
273  
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.  
Make sure the guides in the tray or the multipurpose feeder are properly positioned and are not pressing tightly  
against the paper or envelopes.  
Push the tray firmly into the printer after loading paper.  
If you are loading prepunched paper for use with the staple finisher, then make sure the holes on the long edge of  
the paper are on the right side of the tray. For more information, see the “Loading paper and specialty media”  
section of the User’s Guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
274  
Allow the paper to enter the optional mailbox bins properly  
Make sure to adjust the bin extender so that the paper size indicators match the size of the paper used.  
Notes:  
If the bin extender is shorter than the size of the paper you are printing on, then the paper causes a jam in  
the mailbox bin. For example, if you are printing on a legal-size paper and the bin extender is set to letter-  
size, then a jam occurs.  
If the bin extender is longer than the size of the paper you are printing on, then the edges become uneven  
and the paper is not stacked properly. For example, if you are printing on a letter-size paper and the bin  
extender is set to legal-size, then the paper does not stack properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
275  
If paper needs to be returned to the mailbox bin, then insert the paper under the bin arm, and then push the paper  
all the way back.  
Note: If the paper is not under the bin arm, then a jam occurs due to an overfilled bin.  
Use recommended paper  
Use only recommended paper or specialty media.  
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled paper.  
Flex, fan, and straighten paper or specialty media before loading it.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same tray.  
Make sure the paper size and type are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.  
Store paper per manufacturer recommendations.  
Understanding jam messages and locations  
When a jam occurs, a message indicating the jam location and information to clear the jam appears on the printer  
display. Open the doors, covers, and trays indicated on the display to remove the jam.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
276  
Notes:  
When Jam Assist is set to On, the printer flushes blank pages or pages with partial prints to the standard bin  
after a jammed page has been cleared. Check your printed output for blank pages.  
When Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto, the printer reprints jammed pages. However, the Auto setting reprints  
jammed pages if adequate printer memory is available.  
11  
1
10  
9
8
2
3
7
6
4
5
Area name  
Printer control panel message  
What to do  
1
Stapler doors  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open  
stapler door. Leave paper in  
bin. [455–457]  
Remove paper from the stapler bin, and then open the  
stapler outer and inner doors. Then remove the staple  
cartridge, and then remove the jammed staples.  
2
3
4
Duplex area  
Trays  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to clear Pull out tray 1 completely, then push the front duplex  
duplex. [235–239]  
flap down, and then remove the jammed paper.  
[x]page jam, open tray [x]. [24x]  
Remove all paper from the standard bin, and then  
remove the jammed paper.  
Staple finisher rear [x]page jam, remove paper, open  
Open the rear door of the staple finisher, and then  
remove the jammed paper.  
door  
finisher rear door. Leave paper in  
bin. [451]  
5
6
7
Upper door and rear [x]page jam, open upper and lower Open the rear door of the printer and the rear duplex  
duplex area  
rear door. [231–234]  
area, and then remove the jammed paper.  
Upper rear door  
[x]page jam, open upper rear  
Open the upper rear door of the printer, and then  
remove the jammed paper.  
door. [202]  
Mailbox  
[x]page jam, open mailbox rear  
Open the rear door of the mailbox, and then remove  
the jammed paper.  
door. Leave paper in bin. [4yy.xx]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
277  
Area name  
Printer control panel message  
What to do  
8
9
Multipurpose feeder [x]page jam, clear manual  
Remove all paper from the multipurpose feeder, and  
then remove the jammed paper.  
feeder. [250]  
Inside the printer  
[x]page jam, lift front cover to  
Open the front cover and the multipurpose feeder,  
then remove the toner cartridge and the imaging unit,  
and then remove the jammed paper.  
remove cartridge. [200–201]  
10 Standard bin  
[x]page jam, remove standard bin Remove all paper from the standard bin, and then  
jam. [203] remove the jammed paper.  
11 Automatic  
[x]page jam, open automatic feeder Remove all paper from the ADF tray, and then remove  
top cover. [28y.xx] the jammed paper.  
document feeder  
(ADF)  
[x]page jam, lift front cover to remove cartridge. [200–201]  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
1 Lift the front cover, and then pull down the multipurpose feeder door.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
278  
2 Lift the green handle, and then pull out the toner cartridge from the printer.  
3 Place the toner cartridge aside.  
4 Lift the green handle, and then pull out the imaging unit from the printer.  
1
2
5 Place the imaging unit aside on a flat, smooth surface.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may affect the print quality of  
future print jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
279  
6 Pull the jammed paper gently to the right, and then remove it from the printer.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
1
2
Warning—Potential Damage: The jammed paper may be covered with toner, which can stain garments and  
skin.  
7 Install the imaging unit.  
Note: Use the arrows on the side of the printer as a guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
280  
8 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer, and then push the green handle back into place.  
Notes:  
Align the arrows on the guides of the toner cartridge with the arrows in the printer.  
Make sure the cartridge is fully pushed in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
281  
9 Close the multipurpose feeder door and the front cover.  
2
1
10 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, open upper rear door. [202]  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
282  
1 Pull down the rear door.  
2 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
283  
3 Close the rear door.  
4 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, open upper and lower rear door. [231–234]  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
284  
1 Pull down the rear door.  
2 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
285  
3 Close the rear door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
286  
4 Open the rear door of the duplex area, and then push the back of the standard tray.  
1
2
5 Press down the rear duplex flap, then firmly grasp the jammed paper, and then gently pull the paper out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
287  
2
1
6 Insert the standard tray.  
7 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, remove standard bin jam. [203]  
1 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
288  
2 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to clear duplex. [235–239]  
1 Pull out the tray completely.  
Note: Lift the tray slightly, and then pull it out.  
2
3
1
2 Push down the front duplex flap, then firmly grasp the jammed paper, and then gently pull the paper to the right  
and out of the printer.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
289  
2
1
3 Insert the tray.  
4 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, open tray [x]. [24x]  
1 Check which tray is indicated on the printer display, and then pull the tray.  
2 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
290  
3 Insert the tray.  
4 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder. [250]  
1 From the multipurpose feeder, firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
291  
2 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
3 Reload paper into the multipurpose feeder.  
4 Slide the paper guide until it rests lightly against the edge of the paper.  
5 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, open mailbox rear door. Leave paper in  
bin. [4yy.xx]  
1 Open the rear mailbox door, firmly grasp the jammed paper, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
292  
1
2
2 Close the rear mailbox door.  
3 If the jam is in the mailbox bin, then firmly grasp the jammed paper, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
293  
4 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
294  
[x]page jam, open automatic feeder top cover. [28y.xx]  
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF tray.  
Note: The message is cleared when the pages are removed from the ADF tray.  
2 Open the ADF cover.  
3 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
4 Close the ADF cover.  
5 Open the scanner cover.  
6 If the jam is in the bottom ADF door or ADF exit bin, then open the bottom ADF door, and then firmly grasp the  
jammed paper on each side.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
295  
2
1
7 Close the bottom ADF door.  
8 Straighten the edges of the original documents, then load the documents into the ADF, and then adjust the paper  
guide.  
9 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open finisher rear door. Leave  
paper in bin. [451]  
1 Open the rear staple finisher door, and then gently pull the paper out of the finisher.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
296  
1
2
2 Close the staple finisher door.  
3 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open stapler door. Leave paper in  
bin. [455–457]  
1 From the stapler bin, firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
297  
2 Open the stapler outer and inner doors.  
1
2
3 Pull down the latch of the staple cartridge holder, and then pull the holder out of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
298  
4 Use the metal tab to lift the staple guard, and then remove any loose staples.  
5 Press down the staple guard until it clicks into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
299  
6 Slide the staples toward the metal bracket.  
Note: If the staples are at the rear of the cartridge, then shake the cartridge downward to bring the staples near  
the metal bracket.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not tap the cartridge on a hard surface. This could damage the cartridge.  
7 Push the cartridge holder firmly back into the stapler unit until the cartridge holder clicks into place.  
8 Close the stapler door.  
9 From the printer control panel, touch Done to clear the message and continue printing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
300  
Troubleshooting  
Understanding the printer messages  
Cartridge low [88.xy]  
You may need to order a replacement toner cartridge. If necessary, touch Continue on the printer control panel to  
clear the message and continue printing.  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy]  
If necessary, touch Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated pages remain [88.xy]  
You may need to replace the toner cartridge very soon. For more information, see the “Replacing supplies” section of  
the User’s Guide.  
If necessary, touch Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.  
Change [paper source] to [custom string] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, then specify the paper size and type in the Paper menu on the  
printer control panel, and then touch Finished changing paper.  
Touch Reset active bin to reset the active tray for a linked set of trays.  
Cancel the print job.  
Change [paper source] to [custom type name] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, then specify the paper size and type in the Paper menu on the  
printer control panel, and then touch Finished changing paper.  
Touch Reset active bin to reset the active tray for a linked set of trays.  
Cancel the print job.  
Change [paper source] to [paper size] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, then specify the paper size and type in the Paper menu on the  
printer control panel, and then touch Finished changing paper.  
Touch Reset active bin to reset the active tray for a linked set of trays.  
Cancel the print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Troubleshooting  
301  
Change [paper source] to [paper type] [paper size] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, then specify the paper size and type in the Paper menu on the  
printer control panel, and then touch Finished changing paper.  
Touch Reset active bin to reset the active tray for a linked set of trays.  
Cancel the print job.  
Check tray [x] connection  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
If the error occurs a second time, then:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the indicated tray.  
4 Reattach the tray.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
6 Turn the printer back on.  
If the error occurs again, then:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the tray.  
4 Contact customer support.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and resume the job.  
Close door or insert cartridge  
The toner cartridge is missing or not installed properly. Insert the cartridge, and then close all doors and covers.  
Close finisher side door  
Close the side door of the finisher.  
Close flatbed cover and load originals if restarting job [2yy.xx]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Touch Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner glass immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
302  
Touch Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Note: This does not cancel the scan job. All successfully scanned pages will be processed further for copying,  
faxing, or e-mailing.  
Touch Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Close front door  
Close the front door of the printer.  
Close top access cover  
Close the printer top access cover to clear the message.  
Complex page, some data may not have printed [39]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to ignore the message and continue printing.  
Cancel current print job.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Configuration change, some held jobs were not restored [57]  
Held jobs are invalidated because of the following possible changes in the printer:  
The printer firmware has been updated.  
The tray for the print job has been removed.  
The print job is sent from a flash drive that is no longer attached to the USB port.  
The printer hard disk contains print jobs that were stored when the hard disk was installed in a different printer  
model.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Defective flash detected [51]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace the defective flash memory card.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to ignore the message and continue printing.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Disk full [62]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue processing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the printer hard disk.  
Install a printer hard disk with larger capacity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
303  
Disk full, scan job canceled  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue scanning.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the printer hard disk.  
Install a hard disk with higher capacity.  
Disk must be formatted for use in this device  
From the printer control panel, touch Format disk to format the printer hard disk and clear the message.  
Note: Formatting deletes all the files stored in the printer hard disk.  
Disk near full. Securely clearing disk space.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored on the printer hard disk.  
Install a hard disk with higher capacity.  
Empty the hole punch box  
1 Empty the hole punch box.  
For instructions on emptying the hole punch box, from the printer control panel touch More Information.  
2 Reinsert the hole punch box into the finisher, and then touch Continue to clear the message.  
Error reading USB drive. Remove USB.  
An unsupported USB device is inserted. Remove the USB device, and then insert a supported one.  
Error reading USB hub. Remove hub.  
An unsupported USB hub has been inserted. Remove the USB hub, and then install a supported one.  
Fax memory full  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact system administrator.  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on. If the message appears again, then contact your system support  
person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Troubleshooting  
304  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Fax Server setup. If the message appears again, then contact your system support person.  
Fax Station Name not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try either of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Analog Fax setup. If the message appears again after completing the setup, then contact your system  
support person.  
Fax Station Number not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Analog Fax setup. If the message appears again after completing the setup, then contact your system  
support person.  
Imaging unit low [84.xy]  
You may need to order a replacement imaging unit. If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear  
the message and continue printing.  
Imaging unit nearly low [84.xy]  
If necessary, touch Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.  
Imaging unit very low, [x] estimated pages remain [84.xy]  
You may need to replace the imaging unit very soon. For more information, see the “Replacing supplies” section of the  
User’s Guide.  
If necessary, touch Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing.  
Incompatible output bin [x] [59]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Remove the indicated bin.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the  
indicated bin.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Troubleshooting  
305  
Incompatible tray [x] [59]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Remove the indicated tray.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the  
indicated tray.  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper source] [34]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, and then specify the paper size and type in the Paper menu on  
the printer control panel.  
Make sure the correct paper size and type are specified in Print Properties or the Print dialog settings.  
Check if the paper size is correctly set. For example, if MP Feeder Size is set to Universal, then make sure the paper  
is large enough for the data being printed.  
Check the length and width guides and make sure the paper is loaded properly in the tray.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and print using a different tray.  
Cancel the print job.  
Insert hole punch box  
Insert the hole punch box into the finisher, and then touch Continue to clear the message.  
Insert staple cartridge  
Try one or more of the following:  
Insert a staple cartridge.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the staple finisher.  
Insert Tray [x]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Insert the specified tray into the printer.  
Cancel the print job.  
Reset the active bin for a linked set of bins by selecting Reset active bin on the printer control panel.  
Install bin [x]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the specified bin:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Install the specified bin.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
306  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Cancel the print job.  
Reset active bin  
Install duplex  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the duplex unit:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Install the duplex unit.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Restart the printer.  
Cancel the current job.  
Reset the active bin.  
Install Tray [x]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the specified tray:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Install the specified tray.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Cancel the print job.  
Reset the active bin.  
Insufficient memory for Flash Memory Defragment operation [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data in the printer memory.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Insufficient memory to collate job [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to print the part of the job already stored and begin collating the  
rest of the print job.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
307  
Insufficient memory to support Resource Save feature [35]  
Install additional printer memory or touch Continue to disable Resource Save, clear the message, and continue printing.  
Insufficient memory, some Held Jobs were deleted [37]  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Insufficient memory, some held jobs will not be restored [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Delete other held jobs to free up additional printer memory.  
Load [paper source] with [custom string] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the indicated tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray with the correct paper size or type, touch Finished loading paper on the printer control panel.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct paper size and type, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot find a tray with the correct paper type and size, then it prints from the default paper source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load [paper source] with [custom type name] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray with the correct paper size or type, touch Finished loading paper on the printer control panel.  
Note: If the printer detects a tray that has the correct paper size and type, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot detect a tray that has the correct paper size and type, then it prints from the default paper  
source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load [paper source] with [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the specified tray or feeder with the correct size of paper.  
To use the tray or feeder with the correct size of paper, touch Finished loading paper on the printer control panel.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray or feeder that has the correct size of paper, then it feeds from that tray or  
feeder. If the printer cannot find a tray or feeder with the correct size of paper, then it prints from the default  
paper source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
308  
Load [paper source] with [paper type] [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the specified tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper, touch Finished loading paper on the printer control  
panel.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray or feeder that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that tray  
or feeder. If the printer cannot find a tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from  
the default paper source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom string] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
From the printer control panel, touch Prompt each page, paper loaded or Do not prompt, paper loaded to clear  
the message and continue printing.  
From the printer control panel, touch Automatically select paper to use the paper loaded in the tray.  
Cancel the print job.  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom type name] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
From the printer control panel, touch Prompt each page, paper loaded or Do not prompt, paper loaded to clear  
the message and continue printing.  
From the printer control panel, touch Automatically select paper to use the paper loaded in the tray.  
Cancel the print job.  
Load Manual Feeder with [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the feeder with the correct size of paper.  
From the printer control panel, touch Prompt each page, paper loaded or Do not prompt, paper loaded to clear  
the message and continue printing.  
From the printer control panel, touch Automatically select paper to use the paper loaded in the tray.  
Cancel the print job.  
Load Manual Feeder with [paper type] [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
From the printer control panel, touch Prompt each page, paper loaded or Do not prompt, paper loaded to clear  
the message and continue printing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
309  
From the printer control panel, touch Automatically select paper to use the paper loaded in the tray.  
Cancel the print job.  
Load staples  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace or insert the staple cartridge in the finisher.  
For instructions on inserting or replacing a staple cartridge in the finisher, touch More information on the printer  
control panel.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
From the printer control panel, touch Cancel job to cancel the print job.  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy]  
You may need to order a maintenance kit. For more information, contact customer support at  
http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative. If necessary, touch Continue to clear the message and  
continue printing.  
Maintenance kit nearly low [80.xy]  
For more information, contact customer support at http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative. If  
necessary, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Maintenance kit very low, [x] estimated pages remain [80.xy]  
You may need to replace the maintenance kit very soon. For more information, contact customer support at  
http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative. If necessary, touch Continue to clear the message and  
continue printing.  
Memory full [38]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Cancel job to clear the message.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Memory full, cannot print faxes  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message without printing. Held faxes attempt to print after  
the printer is restarted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
310  
Memory full, cannot send faxes  
1 From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and cancel the fax job.  
2 Try one or more of the following:  
Reduce the fax resolution, and then resend the fax job.  
Reduce the number of pages in the fax, and then resend the fax job.  
No analog phone line connected to modem, fax is disabled.  
Connect the printer to an analog phone line.  
Network [x] software error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to continue printing.  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer back on.  
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, contact customer support.  
NonLexmark [supply type], see User’s Guide [33.xy]  
Note: The supply type can be toner cartridge, imaging unit, or fuser.  
The printer has detected a nonLexmark supply or part installed in the printer.  
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-party supplies  
or parts may affect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components.  
All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts, and may deliver unpredictable results if  
third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may damage your Lexmark  
printer or associated components.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Use of third-party supplies or parts can affect warranty coverage. Damage caused by  
the use of third-party supplies or parts may not be covered by the warranty.  
To accept any and all of these risks, and to proceed with the use of non-genuine supplies or parts in your printer, touch  
and hold  
printing.  
and the # on the printer control panel simultaneously for 15 seconds to clear the message and continue  
If you do not want to accept these risks, then remove the third-party supply or part from your printer, and then install  
a genuine Lexmark supply or part.  
Note: For the list of supported supplies, see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User's Guide or visit  
Not enough free space in flash memory for resources [52]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the flash memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
311  
Install a flash memory card with larger capacity.  
Note: Downloaded fonts and macros not previously stored in the flash memory are deleted.  
Paper changes needed  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Use current supplies to clear the message and continue printing.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Parallel port [x] disabled [56]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Enable the parallel port. From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Network/Ports > Parallel [x] > Parallel Buffer > Auto  
Note: The printer discards any data received through the parallel port.  
Printer had to restart. Last job may be incomplete.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
For more information, visit http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.  
Reattach bin [x]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
Reattach the indicated bin.  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the indicated bin.  
4 Reattach the bin.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
6 Turn the printer back on.  
Remove the indicated bin:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the indicated bin.  
4 Contact customer support at http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the specified bin.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
312  
Reattach bins [x] – [y]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
Reattach the indicated bins:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the indicated bins.  
4 Reattach the bins.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
6 Turn the printer back on.  
Remove the indicated bins:  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the indicated bins.  
4 Contact customer support at http://support.lexmark.com or your service representative.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the indicated bins.  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive cartridge [31.xy]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Check if the toner cartridge is missing. If missing, install the toner cartridge.  
For information on installing the cartridge, see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
If the toner cartridge is installed, then remove the unresponsive toner cartridge, and then reinstall it.  
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then the cartridge is defective. Replace the toner  
cartridge.  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive imaging unit [31.xy]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Check if the imaging unit is missing. If missing, install the imaging unit.  
For information on installing the imaging unit, see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
If the imaging unit is installed, then remove the unresponsive imaging unit, and then reinstall it.  
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then the imaging unit is defective. Replace the  
imaging unit.  
Remove defective disk [61]  
Remove and replace the defective printer hard disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
313  
Remove packaging material, [area name]  
Remove any remaining packaging material from the specified location.  
Remove paper from all bins  
Remove the paper from all of the bins. The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from bin [x]  
Remove the paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from [linked set bin name]  
Remove paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically detects paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from standard output bin  
Remove the paper stack from the standard bin.  
Replace all originals if restarting job.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Touch Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Touch Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner immediately after the last successful scan job.  
Touch Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Touch Restart job to restart the scan job with the same settings from the previous scan job.  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated pages remain [88.xy]  
Replace the toner cartridge to clear the message and continue printing. For more information, see the instruction sheet  
that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement cartridge, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace cartridge, printer region mismatch [42.xy]  
Install a toner cartridge that matches the region number of the printer. x indicates the value of the printer region. y  
indicates the value of the cartridge region. x and y can have the following values:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Troubleshooting  
314  
Printer and toner cartridge regions  
Region number  
Region  
0
1
2
3
4
5
9
Global  
United States, Canada  
European Economic Area (EEA), Switzerland  
Asia Pacific, Australia, New Zealand  
Latin America  
Africa, Middle East, rest of Europe  
Invalid  
Notes:  
The x and y values represent .xyin the code that appears on the printer control panel.  
The x and y values must match for printing to continue.  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated pages remain [84.xy]  
Replace the imaging unit to clear the message and continue printing. For more information, see the instruction sheet  
that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace jammed originals if restarting job.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Touch Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Touch Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner immediately after the last successful scan job.  
Touch Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Touch Restart job to restart the scan job with the same settings from the previous scan job.  
Replace last scanned page and jammed originals if restarting job.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Touch Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Touch Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner immediately after the last successful scan job.  
Touch Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Touch Restart job to restart the scan job with the same settings from the previous scan job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
315  
Replace maintenance kit, 0 estimated pages remain [80.xy]  
Contact customer support at http://support.lexmark.comor your service representative, and then report the message.  
The printer is scheduled for maintenance.  
Replace missing fuser [80.xx]  
1 Install the missing fuser. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the replacement part.  
2 From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Replace separator pad  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace the separator pad. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.  
From the printer control panel, touch Ignore to clear the message.  
Replace unsupported cartridge [32.xy]  
Remove the toner cartridge, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s  
Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement cartridge, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace unsupported imaging unit [32.xy]  
Remove the imaging unit, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s  
Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace wiper  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace the fuser wiper in the printer.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Restore held jobs?  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Restore to restore all held jobs stored in the printer hard disk.  
From the printer control panel, touch Do not restore if you do not want to restore any of the print jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Troubleshooting  
316  
Scan document too long  
The scan job exceeds the maximum number of pages. Touch Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Scanner automatic feeder cover open  
Close the ADF cover.  
Scanner disabled by admin [840.01]  
Print without the scanner, or contact your system support person.  
Scanner disabled. Contact system administrator if problem persists. [840.02]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue with scanner disabled to return to the home screen, and then contact your system support person.  
Touch Reboot and automatically enable scanner to cancel the job.  
Note: This attempts to enable the scanner.  
Scanner jam, remove all originals from the scanner [2yy.xx]  
Remove the jammed paper from the scanner.  
Scanner jam, remove jammed originals from the scanner [2yy.xx]  
Remove the jammed paper from the scanner.  
Scanner maintenance required soon, use ADF Kit [80]  
Contact customer support, and then report the message. The printer is scheduled for maintenance.  
Serial option [x] error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to continue printing.  
Check that the serial cable is properly connected and is the correct one for the serial port.  
Check that the serial interface parameters (protocol, baud, parity, and data bits) are set correctly on the printer  
and computer.  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Troubleshooting  
317  
Serial port [x] disabled [56]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the specified serial port.  
Make sure Serial Buffer is not set to Disabled.  
From the printer control panel, set Serial Buffer to Auto in the Serial [x] menu.  
Some held jobs were not restored  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to delete the indicated job.  
Note: Held jobs that are not restored remain in the printer hard disk and are inaccessible.  
Standard network software error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to continue printing.  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, contact customer support.  
Standard USB port disabled [56]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Enable the USB port. From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Network/Ports > USB Buffer > Auto  
Note: The printer discards any data received through the USB port.  
Supply needed to complete job  
Do either of the following:  
Install the missing supply to complete the job.  
Cancel the current job.  
Too many bins attached [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra bins.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
318  
Too many disks installed [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra printer hard disks.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Too many flash options installed [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra flash memory.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Too many trays attached [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra trays.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Tray [x] paper size unsupported  
Replace with a supported paper size.  
Unformatted flash detected [53]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing.  
Format the flash memory.  
Note: If the error message remains, then the flash memory may be defective and needs to be replaced.  
Unsupported camera mode, unplug camera and change mode  
The camera mode does not support PictBridge.  
Unplug the camera, change the mode and plug the camera back into the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
319  
Unsupported disk  
Remove the unsupported printer hard disk, and then insert a supported one.  
Unsupported option in slot [x] [55]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the unsupported option card from the printer controller board, and then replace it with a supported card.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
USB port [x] disabled [56]  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Notes:  
The printer discards any data received through the USB port.  
Make sure the USB Buffer menu is not set to Disabled.  
Weblink server not set up. Contact system administrator.  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Note: If the message appears again, then contact your system support person.  
Solving printer problems  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
320  
Basic printer problems  
The printer is not responding  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Turn on the printer.  
Make sure the printer is turned on.  
Is the printer turned on?  
Step 2  
Press the Sleep button Go to step 3.  
to wake the printer  
from Sleep mode or  
Check if the printer is in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.  
Hibernate mode.  
Is the printer in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Plug one end of the  
power cord into the  
printer and the other to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if one end of the power cord is plugged into the printer and the  
other to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 4  
Unplug the other  
Go to step 5.  
electrical equipment,  
and then turn on the  
printer. If the printer  
does not work, then  
reconnect the other  
electrical equipment.  
Check other electrical equipment plugged into the electrical outlet.  
Does other electrical equipment work?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
Makesureto matchthe  
following:  
Check if the cables connecting the printer and the computer are inserted  
in the correct ports.  
The USB symbol on  
the cable with the  
USB symbol on the  
printer  
Are the cables inserted in the correct ports?  
The appropriate  
Ethernet cable with  
the Ethernet port  
Step 6  
Turn on the switch or Go to step 7.  
reset the breaker.  
Make sure the electrical outlet is not turned off by a switch or breaker.  
Is the electrical outlet turned off by a switch or breaker?  
Step 7  
Connect the printer  
power cord directly to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Go to step 8.  
Check if the printer is plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible  
power supplies, or extension cords.  
Is the printer plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible power  
supplies, or extension cords?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
321  
Action  
Step 8  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 9.  
Connect the printer  
cable securely to the  
printer and the  
computer, print server,  
option, or other  
Check if one end of the printer cable is plugged into a port on the printer  
and the other to the computer, print server, option, or other network  
device.  
network device.  
Is the printer cable securely attached to the printer and the computer,  
print server, option, or other network device?  
Step 9  
Go to step 10.  
Turn off the printer,  
remove all packing  
materials, then  
reinstall the hardware  
options, and then turn  
on the printer.  
Makesureto installall hardwareoptionsproperlyandremoveanypacking  
material.  
Are all hardware options properly installed and all packing material  
removed?  
Step 10  
Go to step 11.  
Go to step 12.  
Use correct printer  
driver settings.  
Check if you have selected the correct port settings in the printer driver.  
Are the port settings correct?  
Step 11  
Install the correct  
printer driver.  
Check the installed printer driver.  
Is the correct printer driver installed?  
Step 12  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Is the printer working?  
Printer display is blank  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Press the Sleep button on the printer control panel.  
Does Readyappear on the printer display?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Turn off the printer,  
and then contact  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Do Please waitand Readyappear on the printer display?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
322  
Hardware and internal option problems  
Cannot detect internal option  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the  
printer.  
Does the internal option operate correctly?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Connect the internal  
option to the controller  
board.  
Check if the internal option is properly installed in the controller board.  
a Turnofftheprinterusingthepowerswitch,andthenunplugthepower  
cord from the electrical outlet.  
b Make sure the internal option is installed in the appropriate connector  
in the controller board.  
c Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded  
electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
Is the internal option properly installed in the controller board?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Reinstall the internal  
option.  
Print a menu settings page, and then check to see if the internal option is  
listed in the Installed Features list.  
Is the internal option listed in the menu settings page?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the internal option is selected.  
It may be necessary to manually add the internal option in the printer  
driver to make it available for print jobs. For more information, see  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the internal option operate correctly?  
Internal print server does not operate correctly  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Check if the internal  
print server is  
supported by the  
printer.  
Reinstall the internal print server.  
a Remove, and then install the internal print server. For more  
Note: An internal print  
server from another  
printer may not work  
with this printer.  
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the internal print server  
is listed in the Installed Features list.  
Is the internal print server listed in the Installed Features list?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
323  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check the cable and the internal print server connection.  
Use the correct cable, and then check if it is securely connected to the  
internal print server.  
Does the internal print server operate correctly?  
Internal Solutions Port does not operate correctly  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Check if you have a  
supported ISP.  
Make sure the Internal Solutions Port (ISP) is installed.  
Note: An ISP from  
a Install the ISP. For more information, see “Installing an Internal  
another printer may  
not work on this  
printer.  
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the ISP is listed in the  
Installed Features list.  
Is the ISP listed in the Installed Features list?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check the cable and the ISP connection.  
a Use the correct cable, and then make sure it is securely connected to  
the ISP.  
b Check if the ISP solution interface cable is securely connected into the  
receptacle of the controller board.  
Note: The ISP solution interface cable and the receptacle on the  
controller board are colorcoded.  
Does the Internal Solutions Port operate correctly?  
Tray problems  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:  
Check for paper jams or misfeeds.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
If you are printing on customsize paper, then make sure that the  
paper guides rest against the edges of the paper.  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
b Check if the tray closes properly.  
Is the tray working?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
324  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a Turn off the printer, then wait about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the tray working?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Reinstall the tray. For  
more information, see  
the setup  
documentation that  
came with the tray.  
Check if the tray is installed and recognized by the printer.  
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the tray is listed in the  
Installed Features list.  
Is the tray listed in the menu settings page?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check if the tray is available in the printer driver.  
Note: If necessary, manually add the tray in the printer driver to make it  
available for print jobs. For more information, see “Updating available  
Is the tray available in the printer driver?  
USB/parallel interface card does not operate correctly  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Check if you have a  
supported USB or  
parallel interface card.  
Make sure the USB or parallel interface card is installed.  
a Install the USB or parallel interface card. For more information, see  
Note: A USB or parallel  
interface card from  
another printer may  
not work on this  
printer.  
b Print a menu settings page, and then check if the USB or parallel  
interface card is listed in the Installed Features list.  
Is the USB or parallel interface card listed in the Installed Features list?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check the cable and the USB or parallel interface card connection.  
Use the correct cable, and then make sure it is securely connected to  
the USB or parallel interface card.  
Does the USB or parallel interface card operate correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
325  
Paper feed problems  
Jammed pages are not reprinted  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Turn on Jam Recovery.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery  
b From the Jam Recovery menu, touch the arrows to scroll to Onor  
Auto.  
c Touch Submit.  
Do pages reprint after a jam?  
Paper frequently jams  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
Check if the paper guides are aligned against the edges of the  
paper.  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Check if you are printing on a recommended paper size and type.  
b Insert the tray properly.  
If jam recovery is enabled, then the print jobs will reprint  
automatically.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Step 3  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Review the tips on avoiding jams. For more information, see “Avoiding  
b Follow the recommendations, and then resend the print job.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
326  
Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Check the entire paper path for jammed paper.  
a Remove any jammed paper.  
Contact customer  
b From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Does the paper jam message remain?  
Solving print problems  
Printing problems  
Confidential and other held jobs do not print  
Note: Confidential, Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to  
process additional held jobs.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
Select one of the Print  
and Hold options, and  
then resend the print  
job. For more  
Open the held jobs folder on the printer display, and then verify that your  
print job is listed.  
information, see  
Is your print job listed in the held jobs folder?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data.  
Delete the print job, and then send it again.  
For PDF files, generate a new PDF, and then print it again.  
If you are printing from the Internet, then the printer may be reading  
multiple job titles as duplicates and deleting all jobs except the first one.  
For Windows users  
a Open the Print Properties folder.  
b Fromthe PrintandHolddialog, selectthe “Keepduplicate documents”  
check box.  
c Enter a PIN number.  
For Macintosh users  
Save each print job, name each job differently, and then send the  
individual jobs to the printer.  
Does the job print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
327  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Add additional printer  
memory.  
Free up additional printer memory by deleting some of the held jobs.  
Does the job print?  
Envelope seals when printing  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Use envelopes that have been stored in a dry environment.  
Note: Printing on envelopes with high moisture content can seal the  
flaps.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the envelope seal when printing?  
Error message about reading the flash drive appears  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Insert the flash drive  
into the front USB port.  
Check if the flash drive is inserted into the front USB port.  
Note: The flash drive will not work if it is inserted into the rear USB  
port.  
Is the flash drive inserted into the front USB port?  
Step 2  
Wait until the printer is Go to step 3.  
ready, then view the  
held jobs list, and then  
Check if the indicator light on the printer control panel is blinking green.  
Note: A green blinking light indicates that the printer is busy.  
print the documents.  
Is the indicator light blinking green?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
a Check for an error message on the display.  
b Clear the message.  
Does the error message still appear?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved.  
Check if the flash drive is supported.  
For more information on tested and approved USB flash drives, see  
Does the error message still appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
328  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Check if the USB port is disabled by the system support person.  
Does the error message still appear?  
Incorrect characters print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Deactivate Hex Trace Go to step 2.  
mode.  
Make sure the printer is not in Hex Trace mode.  
Note: If Ready Hexappears on the printer display, then turn off the  
printer, and then turn it back on to deactivate Hex Trace mode.  
Is the printer in Hex Trace mode?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a From the printer control panel, select Standard Network or  
Network [x], and then set SmartSwitch to On.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do incorrect characters print?  
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Check if you are printing on paper that is supported by the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, set the paper size  
and type to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
a Depending on your operating system, open Printing Preferences or  
the Print dialog, and then specify the paper type.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
329  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the trays are not linked.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Large jobs do not collate  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the Finishing menu on the printer control panel, set Collate to  
(1,2,3) (1,2,3).  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a From the printer software, set Collate to (1,2,3) (1,2,3).  
Note: Setting Collate to (1,1,1) (2,2,2) in the software overrides the  
setting in the Finishing menu.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Reduce the complexity of the print job by eliminating the number and size  
of fonts, the number and complexity of images, and the number of pages  
in the job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Multiplelanguage PDF files do not print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Check if the print options for the PDF output are set to embed all fonts.  
For more information, see the documentation that came with Adobe  
Acrobat.  
b Generate a new PDF file, and then resend the print job.  
Do the files print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
330  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Open the document you want to print in Adobe Acrobat.  
b Click File > Print > Advanced > Print As Image > OK > OK.  
Do the files print?  
Printing slows down  
Notes:  
When printing using narrow paper, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the fuser.  
The printer speed may be reduced when printing for long periods of time, or printing at elevated temperatures.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the fuser  
type.  
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and a  
220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the print speed increase?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser, see  
the instruction sheet that came with the part.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the print speed increase?  
Print jobs do not print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the document you are trying to print, open the Print dialog and  
check if you have selected the correct printer.  
Note: If the printer is not the default printer, then you must select  
the printer for each document that you want to print.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
331  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a Check if the printer is plugged in and turned on, and if Readyappears  
on the printer display.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved. Go to step 5.  
Ifan error message appears on the printerdisplay, thenclear the message.  
Note: The printer continues to print after clearing the message.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 4  
a Check if the ports (USB, serial, or Ethernet) are working and if the  
cables are securely connected to the computer and the printer.  
Note: For more information, see the setup documentation that  
came with the printer.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Go to step 6.  
a Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 6  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Remove, and then reinstall the printer software. For more  
Note: The printer software is available at  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
332  
Print job takes longer than expected  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Change the environmental settings of the printer.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings  
b Select EcoMode or Quiet Mode, and then select Off.  
Note: Disabling Eco-Mode or Quiet Mode may increase the  
consumption of energy or supplies, or both.  
Did the job print?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
Reduce the number and size of fonts, the number and complexity of  
images, and the number of pages in the print job, and then resend the job  
Did the job print?  
Step 3  
a Remove held jobs stored in the printer memory.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Go to step 5.  
a Disable the Page Protect feature.  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery > Page Protect > Off  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Go to step 6.  
a Check if the cable connections to the printer and print server are  
secure. For moreinformation, seethesetupdocumentation thatcame  
with the printer.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Step 6  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Install additional printer memory, and then resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
333  
Tray linking does not work  
Notes:  
The trays can detect paper length.  
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect the paper size. You must set the size from the Paper  
Size/Type menu.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Open the trays, and then check if they contain paper of the same size  
and type.  
Check if the paper guides are in the correct positions for the size  
of the paper loaded in each tray.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the trays link correctly?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in thePaper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the trays to be linked.  
Note: The paper size and type must match for trays to be linked.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the trays link correctly?  
Unexpected page breaks occur  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Increase the printing timeout.  
The problem is solved. Check the original file  
for manual page  
breaks.  
a From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Timeouts  
b Increase the Print Timeout setting, and then touch Submit.  
c Resend the print job.  
Did the file print correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
334  
Print quality problems  
Characters have jagged or uneven edges  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Go to step 2.  
a Print a font sample listto checkif thefonts you areusing are supported  
by the printer.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Reports > Print Fonts  
2 Touch PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.  
b Use a font that is supported by the printer or install the font that you  
want to use. For more information, contact your system support  
person.  
c Resend the print job.  
Do prints still contain characters that have jagged or uneven edges?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Use a font that is supported by the printer or install the font that you  
want to use on your computer. For more information, contact your  
system support person.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do prints still contain characters that have jagged or uneven edges?  
Clipped pages or images  
Leading edge  
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
Trailing edge  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
335  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the paper loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
size from the tray  
settings to match  
the paper loaded in  
the tray.  
Do the paper size and type match the paper loaded in the tray?  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
size specified in the  
tray settings.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size from  
Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge.  
2 Remove the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Compressed images appear on prints  
Note: Printing on letter-size paper using a 220-volt fuser compresses images.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
336  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the fuser  
type.  
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and a  
220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do compressed images still appear?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser, see  
the instruction sheet that came with the part.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do compressed images still appear?  
Gray background on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the Quality Menu on the printer control panel, decrease the  
toner darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Reinstall the imaging unit and the toner cartridge.  
a Remove the toner cartridge.  
b Remove the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light  
can cause print quality problems.  
c Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
d Resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
337  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Horizontal voids appear on prints  
Leading edge  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 3  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
338  
Incorrect margins on prints  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the paper size loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Are the margins correct?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size in the Paper menu to  
match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
size from the tray  
settings to match  
the paper loaded in  
the tray.  
Does the paper size match the paper loaded in the tray?  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
size specified in the  
tray settings.  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size from  
Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Are the margins correct?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
339  
Paper curl  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Adjust the width and  
length guides.  
Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions for  
the size of the paper loaded.  
Are the width and length guides positioned correctly?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Specify the paper type  
and weight from the  
tray settings to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the paper in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Remove the paper from the tray, and then turn it over.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Printer is printing blank pages  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
340  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if there is packing material left on the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Checkifthepackingmaterialisproperlyremovedfromtheimaging  
unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Step 3  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Printer is printing solid black pages  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
341  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer printing solid black pages?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the printer printing solid black pages?  
Print irregularities  
Leading edge  
)
)
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the size of the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Specify the paper size  
and type from the tray  
settings to match the  
paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the printer settings match the type and weight of the paper loaded in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
342  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, set the  
paper texture in the  
Paper menu to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
Go to step 5.  
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Step 6  
Contact customer  
k.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Print is too dark  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a From the Quality menu on the printer control panel, reduce the toner  
darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
343  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture and weight  
in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
type, texture, and  
weight from the  
tray settings to  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?  
match the paper  
loaded in the tray.  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
type, texture and  
weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, change  
the texture settings in  
the Paper Texture  
menu to match the  
paper you are printing  
on.  
Go to step 5.  
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Step 6  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
344  
Print is too light  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Fromthe Qualitymenu on the printercontrolpanel, increasethetoner  
darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper type,  
texture, and weight to  
match the paper  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture, and weight in  
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
loaded in the tray.  
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture,  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, change  
the texture settings in  
the Paper Texture  
menu to match the  
paper you are printing  
on.  
Go to step 5.  
Make sure that the paper has no texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
345  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 7  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Repeating defects appear on prints  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Replace the imaging unit if the distance between the defects is equal  
to any of the following:  
47.8 mm (1.88 in.)  
96.8 mm (3.81 in.)  
28.5 mm (1.12 in.)  
b Resend the print job.  
Do repeating defects still appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Replace the fuser if the distance between the defects is equal to either  
of the following:  
94.25 mm (3.71 in.)  
95.2 mm (3.75 in.)  
b Resend the print job.  
Do repeating defects still appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
346  
Shadow images appear on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
Load paper with the  
correct paper type and  
weight in the tray.  
Load paper with the correct paper type and weight in the tray.  
Is paper with the correct paper type and weight loaded in the tray?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray to  
match the paper type  
and weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Is the tray set to the type and weight of the paper loaded?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do shadow images still appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do shadow images still appear on prints?  
Skewed print  
)
)
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
347  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the size of the paper loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still skewed?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if you are printing on a paper that is supported by the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still skewed?  
Streaked horizontal lines appear on prints  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the tray or feeder from  
Printing Preferences or the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper type  
and weight to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the paper in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
348  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Streaked vertical lines appear on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture,  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper texture, type, and weight in  
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
texture, type, and  
weight from the  
tray settings to  
Do the paper texture, type, and weight match the paper in the tray?  
match the paper  
loaded in the tray.  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
texture, type, and  
weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
349  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
k.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Toner fog or background shading appears on prints  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the toner fog or background shading disappear from the prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
350  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Did the toner fog or background shading disappear from the prints?  
Toner rubs off  
Leading edge  
ABC  
DEF  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Specify the paper type  
and weight from the  
tray settings to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, check the paper type  
and weight.  
Do the paper type and weight match the paper loaded in the tray?  
Step 2  
From the Paper menu Contact customer  
on the printer control support.  
panel, set the paper  
Check if you are printing on paper that is heavy or has texture or rough  
finishes.  
texture.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Toner specks appear on prints  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Do toner specks appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
351  
Transparency print quality is poor  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Set the paper type to  
Transparency.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type in the Paper menu to  
match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Is the paper type for the tray set to Transparency?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if you are using a recommended type of transparency.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print quality still poor?  
Uneven print density  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Is the print density uneven?  
Vertical voids appear on prints  
Leading edge  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
352  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved.  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the  
Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
Check if you are using a recommended type of paper.  
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Solving copy problems  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
353  
Copier does not respond  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Does an error or status message appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn it back  
on.  
Did Performing Self Testand Readyappear?  
Partial document or photo copies  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Change the paper size  
setting to match the  
paper loaded in the  
tray, or load the tray  
with paper that  
matches the paper size  
setting.  
Check if the paper size setting matches the size of the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, check the Paper  
Size setting.  
Does the paper size setting match the size of the paper loaded in the tray.  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Specify the paper size. Depending on your operating system, specify  
the paper size in Printing Preferences or the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do copies print properly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
354  
Poor copy quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Does an error or status message appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Increase the scan  
resolution setting for a  
higherquality output.  
Check the quality of the original document.  
Is the quality of the original document satisfactory?  
Step 3  
If dark marks appear on prints, then clean the scanner glass and the ADF  
glass using a clean, lint-free cloth dampened with water.  
Is the scanner glass clean?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Send a print job, and then check for print quality problems.  
a From the General Settings menu, adjust the EcoMode settings.  
b From the Copy menu, adjust the Darkness setting.  
c If the print remains faded, then replace the toner cartridge.  
Is the print quality satisfactory?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
Go to step 7.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Step 6  
Change the Content  
Type and Content  
Source settings to  
match the document  
being scanned.  
Check the copy settings.  
From the Copy screen, check if the Content Type and Content Source  
settings are correct for the document being scanned.  
Are the Content Type and Content Source settings correct for the  
document being scanned?  
Step 7  
Go to step 8.  
The problem is solved.  
Check for patterns on prints.  
a From the Copy screen, navigate to:  
Advanced Options > Advanced Imaging > Sharpness > select a lower  
setting  
Note: Make sure no scaling is being selected.  
b Resend the copy job.  
Do patterns appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
355  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 8  
Go to step 9.  
Check for missing or faded text on prints.  
a From the Copy screen, navigate to:  
Advanced Options > Advanced Imaging  
b Adjust the settings:  
Sharpness—Increase the current setting.  
Contrast—Increase the current setting.  
c Resend the copy job.  
Do prints have missing or faded text?  
Step 9  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Check for washedout or overexposed output.  
a From the Copy screen, navigate to:  
Advanced Options > Advanced Imaging  
b Adjust the settings of the following:  
Background Removal—Reduce the current setting.  
Shadow Detail—Reduce the current setting.  
c Resend the copy job.  
Do pages show washedout or overexposed prints?  
Scanner unit does not close  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if there are no obstructions between the scanner unit and the  
printer.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Lift the scanner unit.  
b Remove any obstruction that keeps the scanner unit open.  
c Lower the scanner unit.  
Did the scanner unit close properly?  
Solving fax problems  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
356  
Caller ID is not shown  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Contact your telephone company to check if your telephone line is  
subscribed to the caller ID service.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Notes:  
If your region supports multiple caller ID patterns, then you may  
have to change the default setting. There are two settings  
available: FSK (pattern 1) and DTMF (pattern 2).  
The availability of these settings in the Fax menu depends on  
whether your country or region supports multiple caller ID  
patterns.  
Contact your telephone company to determine which pattern or  
switch setting to use.  
Does the caller ID appear?  
Cannot send or receive a fax  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Is there an error or status message on the display?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 3  
Turn on the printer,  
and then wait until  
Readyappears on the  
display.  
Check the power.  
Check if the printer is plugged in and turned on, and if Readyappears  
on the display.  
Is the printer turned on, and does Readyappear on the display?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Securely connect the  
cables.  
Check the printer connections.  
If applicable, check if the cable connections for the following  
equipment are secure:  
Telephone  
Handset  
Answering machine  
Are the cable connections secure?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
357  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Go to step 6.  
a Check the telephone wall jack.  
1 Plug the telephone cable into the wall jack.  
2 Listen for a dial tone.  
3 If you do not hear a dial tone, then plug a different telephone cable  
into the wall jack.  
4 If you still do not hear a dial tone, then plug the telephone cable  
into a different wall jack.  
5 If you hear a dial tone, then connect the printer to that wall jack.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
Connect the printer to  
an analog phone  
service or the correct  
digital connector.  
Check if the printer is connected to an analog phone service or the correct  
digital connector.  
The fax modem is an analog device. Certain devices can be connected  
to the printer so that digital telephone services can be used.  
If you are using an ISDN telephone service, then connect the  
printer to an analog telephone port (an R-interface port) on an  
ISDN terminal adapter. For more information and to request an R-  
interface port, contact your ISDN provider.  
If you are using DSL, then connect to a DSL filter or router that will  
support analog use. For more information, contact your DSL  
provider.  
If you are using a PBX telephone service, then make sure you are  
connectingto an analog connectionon thePBX. If noneexists, then  
consider installing an analog telephone line for the fax machine.  
Is the printer connected to an analog phone service or the correct digital  
connector?  
Step 7  
Go to step 8.  
Try calling the fax  
number to make  
sure that it is  
Check for a dial tone.  
working properly.  
Did you hear a dial tone?  
If the telephone  
line is being used by  
another device,  
then wait until the  
other device is  
finished before  
sending a fax.  
If you are using the  
On Hook Dial  
feature, then turn  
up the volume to  
check if you hear a  
dial tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
358  
Action  
Step 8  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 9.  
Temporarily disconnect other equipment (such as answering machines,  
computers with modems, or telephone line splitters) between the printer  
and the telephone line, and then try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 9  
The problem is solved. Go to step 10.  
a Temporarily disable call waiting. Contact your telephone company to  
obtain the keypad sequence for temporarily disabling call waiting.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 10  
The problem is solved. Go to step 11.  
a Temporarily disable voice mail service. For more information, contact  
your telephone company.  
Note: If you want to use both voice mail and the printer, then  
consider adding a second telephone line for the printer.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 11  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Scan the original document one page at a time.  
a Dial the fax number.  
b Scan the document one page at a time.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Can receive but not send faxes  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Check if the printer is in Fax mode.  
From the home screen, touch Fax to put the printer in Fax mode, and  
then send the fax.  
Note: The Multi Send application does not support the XPS output type.  
To use XPS, use the regular faxing method.  
Can you send faxes?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
359  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Load the original document properly.  
Load the original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray  
or facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo  
paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings) into the ADF tray.  
Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Can you send faxes?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Set up the shortcut number properly.  
Check if the shortcut number has been set for the telephone number  
that you want to dial.  
Dial the telephone number manually.  
Can you send faxes?  
Can send but not receive faxes  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Check the tray or feeder.  
If empty, then load paper in the tray or feeder.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Check the ring count delay settings.  
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the  
address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP  
address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods,  
such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to  
load the Web page correctly.  
b Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
c In the “Rings to Answer” field, enter the number of times you want  
the phone to ring before the printer answers.  
d Click Submit.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
360  
Action  
Step 3  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the toner cartridge. For more information, see the instruction  
sheet that came with the supply.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Fax and e-mail functions are not set up  
Notes:  
Before you troubleshoot, check if the fax cables are connected.  
The indicator light is blinking red until you set up fax and email.  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a From the home screen, navigate to:  
> Settings > General Settings > Run initial setup > Yes >  
Submit  
b Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
The “Select your language” screen appears on the printer display.  
c Select a language, and then touch  
.
d Select a country or region, and then touch Next.  
e Select a time zone, and then touch Next.  
f Select Fax and Email, and then touch Next.  
Are fax and email functions set up?  
Received fax has poor print quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Ask the person who sent you the fax to:  
a Check if the quality of the original document is satisfactory.  
b Increase the fax scan resolution, if possible.  
c Resend the fax.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
361  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Decrease the incoming fax transmission speed.  
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the  
address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer home screen. The IP  
address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods,  
such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to  
load the Web page correctly.  
Print a network setup page or menu settings page, and then  
locate the IP address in the TCP/IP section.  
b Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
c In the Max Speed menu, click one of the following:  
2400  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
d Click Submit, and then resend the fax.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the toner cartridge.  
When Cartridge low [88.xy]appears, replace the cartridge,  
and then resend the fax.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Solving scanner problems  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
362  
Cannot scan from a computer  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 2.  
Make sure the printer is turned on and that Readyappears on the printer  
display before scanning a job.  
Does Readyappear before scanning the job?  
Step 2  
Clear the error  
message.  
Go to step 3.  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Is there an error message on the printer display?  
Step 3  
Contact customer  
Tighten the cable  
connections.  
Check the cable connections between the printer and the print server to  
make sure they are secure.  
For more information, see the setup documentation that came with  
the printer.  
Are the cable connections between the printer and the print server  
secure?  
Partial document or photo scans  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Contact customer  
Load the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Poor scanned image quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Clear the error  
message.  
Go to step 2.  
Check if an error message appears on the display.  
Is there an error message on the printer display?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Increase the scan  
resolutionsettingsfor a  
higherquality output.  
Check the quality of the original document.  
Is the quality of the original document satisfactory?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
363  
Action  
Step 3  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 4.  
Clean the scanner glass and the ADF glass using a clean, lintfree cloth  
dampened with water.  
Is the scanner glass clean?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Go to step 6.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Step 5  
Send a print job, and then check for print quality problems.  
From the General Settings menu, adjust the EcoMode settings.  
From the Copy menu, adjust the Darkness setting.  
When the print becomes faded, replace the toner cartridge.  
Is the print quality satisfactory?  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
Change the Content  
Type and Content  
Source settings to  
match the document  
being scanned.  
Check the scan settings.  
FromtheScanscreen, makesuretheContentTypeandContentSource  
settings are correct for the document being scanned.  
Are the Content Type and Content Source settings correct for the  
document being scanned?  
Step 7  
Problem solved.  
Contact customer  
Increase the scan resolution settings for a higherquality output.  
Did the increased resolution produce a higherquality output?  
Scan job was not successful  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Connect the cables  
properly.  
Check the cable connections.  
Make sure the Ethernet or USB cable is securely connected to the  
computer and the printer.  
Are the cables securely connected?  
Step 2  
Change the file name. Go to step 3.  
Check if the file name is already in use.  
Is the file name already in use?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
364  
Action  
Step 3  
Yes  
No  
Close the file you are Go to step 4.  
scanning.  
Check if the document or photo you want to scan is open in another  
application or being used by another user.  
Is the file you want to scan open by another application or user?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
Selectthe Appendtime  
stamp or Overwrite  
existing file check box  
in the destination  
CheckifeithertheAppendtimestamportheOverwriteexisting file check  
box is selected in the destination configuration settings.  
configuration settings.  
Is the Append time stamp or Overwrite existing file check box selected  
in the destination configuration settings?  
Scanner unit does not close  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if there are obstructions in the scanner unit.  
a Lift the scanner unit.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
b Remove any obstruction keeping the scanner unit open.  
c Lower the scanner unit.  
Did the scanner unit close correctly?  
Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
Check if other applications are interfering with the scan.  
Close all applications that are not being used.  
Does scanning still take too long or freeze the computer?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Select a lower scan resolution.  
Does scanning still take too long or freeze the computer?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
365  
The scanner does not respond  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Turn on the printer.  
Check if the printer is turned on.  
Is the printer turned on?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Connect the printer  
cable securely to the  
printer and the  
computer, print server,  
option, or other  
network device.  
Check if the printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the  
computer, print server, option, or other network device.  
Is the printer cable securely attached to the printer and the computer,  
print server, option, or other network device?  
Step 3  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 4  
Turn on the switch or Go to step 5.  
reset the breaker.  
Check if the electrical outlet is turned off by a switch or breaker.  
Is the electrical outlet turned off by a switch or breaker?  
Step 5  
Connect the printer  
power cord directly to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Go to step 6.  
Go to step 7.  
Check if the printer is plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible  
power supplies, or extension cords.  
Is the printer plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible power  
supplies, or extension cords?  
Step 6  
Unplug the other  
electrical equipment  
and turn on the printer.  
If the printer does not  
work, then reconnect  
the other electrical  
equipment and then go  
to step 6.  
Check other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet.  
Are the other electrical equipment working?  
Step 7  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Are the printer and scanner working?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
366  
Solving home screen applications problems  
An application error has occurred  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Contact customer  
Check the system log for relevant details.  
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the  
address field.  
If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then you can:  
View the IP address on the printer home screen.  
Print a network setup page or the menu settings pages, and then  
locate the IP address in the TCP/IP section.  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by  
periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
b Click Settings > Apps > Apps Management > System tab > Log.  
c From the Filter menu, select an application status.  
d From the Application menu, select an application, and then click  
Submit.  
Does an error message appear in the log?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Resolve the error.  
Is the application working now?  
Embedded Web Server does not open  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Type the correct  
printerIPaddressinthe  
address field of your  
Web browser.  
Make sure the printer IP address is correct.  
View the printer IP address:  
From the printer home screen  
Note: Depending on  
the network settings,  
you may need to type  
https://” instead of  
http://” before the  
printer IP address to  
access the Embedded  
Web Server.  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then  
finding the TCP/IP section  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by  
periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
Is the printer IP address correct?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Turn on the printer.  
Check if the printer is turned on.  
Is the printer turned on?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
367  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Contact your system  
support person.  
Check if the network connection is working.  
Is the network connection working?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Go to step 6.  
Tighten the cable  
connection.  
Makesurethecableconnectionsto theprinterandprintserveraresecure.  
For more information, see the setup documentation that came with  
the printer.  
Are the cable connections to the printer and print server secure?  
Step 5  
Contact your system  
support person.  
Temporarily disable the Web proxy servers.  
Note: Proxy servers may block or restrict you from accessing certain  
Web sites including the Embedded Web Server.  
Are the Web proxy servers disabled?  
Step 6  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Access the Embedded Web Server again by typing the correct IP address  
in the address field.  
Did the Embedded Web Server open?  
Contacting customer support  
When you contact customer support, describe the problem you are experiencing, the printer control panel light  
sequence, and the troubleshooting steps you have already taken to find a solution.  
You need to know your printer model type and serial number. For more information, see the label on the inside top  
front cover of the printer. The serial number is also listed on the menu settings page.  
Lexmark has various ways to help you solve your printing problem. Visit the Lexmark Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com, and then select one of the following:  
Tech Library You can browse our library of manuals, support documentation, drivers, and other downloads to help you  
solve common problems.  
E-mail  
You can send an e-mail to the Lexmark team, describing your problem. A service representative will respond  
and provide you with information to solve your problem.  
Live chat  
You can chat directly with a service representative. They can work with you to solve your printer problem or  
provide assistance through Assisted Service where the service representative can remotely connect to your  
computer through the Internet to troubleshoot problems, install updates, or complete other tasks to help  
you successfully use your Lexmark product.  
Telephone support is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries or regions, visit the  
Lexmark Web site at http://support.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
368  
Notices  
Product information  
Product name:  
Lexmark XM7155, XM7163, and XM7170  
Machine type:  
7463  
Model(s):  
496, 696, 896  
Edition notice  
September 2012  
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law:  
LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain  
transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.  
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the  
information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the products or  
the programs described may be made at any time.  
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make  
these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is not intended to  
state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally equivalent product, program,  
or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead. Evaluation and verification  
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services, except those expressly designated by the  
manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.  
For Lexmark technical support, visit http://support.lexmark.com.  
For information on supplies and downloads, visit www.lexmark.com.  
If you don't have access to the Internet, you can contact Lexmark by mail:  
Lexmark International, Inc.  
Bldg 004-2/CSC  
740 New Circle Road NW  
Lexington, KY 40550  
USA  
© 2012 Lexmark International, Inc.  
All rights reserved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notices  
369  
GOVERNMENT END USERS  
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is defined in 48 C.F.R.  
2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R.  
12.212or48C.F.R.227.7202,asapplicable. Consistentwith48C.F.R. 12.212or48C.F.R. 227.7202-1through227.7207-4,  
as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software Documentation are licensed to the U.S.  
Government end users (a) only as Commerical Items and (b) with only those rights as are granted to all other end users  
pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.  
Trademarks  
Lexmark, Lexmark with diamond design, MarkNet, and MarkVision are trademarks of Lexmark International, Inc.,  
registered in the United States and/or other countries.  
ScanBack is a trademark of Lexmark International, Inc.  
Mac and the Mac logo are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.  
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s designation of a  
set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer is intended to be  
compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used in various application  
programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.  
The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of these companies:  
Albertus  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Monsieur Marcel OLIVE  
Antique Olive  
Apple-Chancery  
Arial  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
CG Times  
Based on Times New Roman under license from The Monotype Corporation plc, is a product of  
Agfa Corporation  
Chicago  
Clarendon  
Eurostile  
Geneva  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Nebiolo  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
GillSans  
Helvetica  
Hoefler  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Jonathan Hoefler Type Foundry  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic International Typeface Corporation  
ITC Bookman  
ITC Mona Lisa  
ITC Zapf Chancery  
Joanna  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Arthur Baker  
Marigold  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
370  
Monaco  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
New York  
Oxford  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Arthur Baker  
Palatino  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Agfa Corporation  
Stempel Garamond  
Taffy  
Times New Roman  
Univers  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information statement  
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference,  
and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy  
and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio  
communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference, in which case  
the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than recommended  
cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could  
void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing device,  
use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach or 1021294 for  
USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC  
regulations.  
Licensing notices  
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the root directory of the documentation CD.  
Noise emission levels  
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO 9296.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA  
Printing  
Scanning  
Copying  
56 dBA  
57 dBA  
56 dBA  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
371  
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA  
Ready  
30 dBA  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive  
The WEEE logo signifies specific recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the European  
Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.  
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com for your local  
sales office phone number.  
Product disposal  
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local authorities  
for disposal and recycling options.  
Static sensitivity notice  
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch in the areas near these symbols without first touching the  
metal frame of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
372  
ENERGY STAR  
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is certified to comply  
with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as configured when shipped by Lexmark.  
Temperature information  
Ambient operating temperature  
Shipping and storage temperature  
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)  
1 to 35°C (34 to 95°F)  
Laser notice  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR Chapter I, Subchapter J for Class I  
(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains internally a Class IIIb (3b) laser that is  
nominally a 10 milliwatt gallium arsenide laser operating in the wavelength of 787-800 nanometers. The laser system  
and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal  
operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.  
Laser advisory label  
A laser notice label may be affixed to this printer as shown:  
DANGER - Invisible laser radiation when cartridges are removed and interlock defeated. Avoid exposure to laser beam.  
PERIGO - Radiação a laser invisível será liberada se os cartuchos forem removidos e o lacre rompido. Evite a exposição aos feixes de laser.  
Opasnost - Nevidljivo lasersko zračenje kada su kasete uklonjene i poništena sigurnosna veza. Izbjegavati izlaganje zracima.  
NEBEZPEČÍ - Když jsou vyjmuty kazety a je odblokována pojistka, ze zařízení je vysíláno neviditelné laserové záření. Nevystavujte se působení laserového paprsku.  
FARE - Usynlig laserstråling, når patroner fjernes, og spærreanordningen er slået fra. Undgå at blive udsat for laserstrålen.  
GEVAAR - Onzichtbare laserstraling wanneer cartridges worden verwijderd en een vergrendeling wordt genegeerd. Voorkom blootstelling aan de laser.  
DANGER - Rayonnements laser invisibles lors du retrait des cartouches et du déverrouillage des loquets. Eviter toute exposition au rayon laser.  
VAARA - Näkymätöntä lasersäteilyä on varottava, kun värikasetit on poistettu ja lukitus on auki. Vältä lasersäteelle altistumista.  
GEFAHR - Unsichtbare Laserstrahlung beim Herausnehmen von Druckkassetten und offener Sicherheitssperre. Laserstrahl meiden.  
ΚΙΝΔΥΝΟΣ - Έκλυση αόρατης ακτινοβολίας laser κατά την αφαίρεση των κασετών και την απασφάλιση της μανδάλωσης. Αποφεύγετε την έκθεση στην ακτινοβολία laser.  
VESZÉLY – Nem látható lézersugárzás fordulhat elő a patronok eltávolításakor és a zárószerkezet felbontásakor. Kerülje a lézersugárnak való kitettséget.  
PERICOLO - Emissione di radiazioni laser invisibili durante la rimozione delle cartucce e del blocco. Evitare l´esposizione al raggio laser.  
FARE – Usynlig laserstråling når kassettene tas ut og sperren er satt ut av spill. Unngå eksponering for laserstrålen.  
NIEBEZPIECZEŃSTWO - niewidzialne promieniowanie laserowe podczas usuwania kaset i blokady. Należy unikać naświetlenia promieniem lasera.  
ОПАСНО! Невидимое лазерное излучение при извлеченных картриджах и снятии блокировки. Избегайте воздействия лазерных лучей.  
Pozor – Nebezpečenstvo neviditeľného laserového žiarenia pri odobratých kazetách a odblokovanej poistke. Nevystavujte sa lúčom.  
PELIGRO: Se producen radiaciones láser invisibles al extraer los cartuchos con el interbloqueo desactivado. Evite la exposición al haz de láser.  
FARA – Osynlig laserstrålning när patroner tas ur och spärrmekanismen är upphävd. Undvik exponering för laserstrålen.  
- 当移除碳粉盒及互失效生看不的激光射,避免暴露在激光光束下。  
危險 - 移除碳粉匣與安全連續開關失效時會生看不見的雷射輻射。請避免曝露在雷射光束下。  
危険 - カートリッジが取り外され、内部ロックが無効になると、見えないレーザー光が放射されます。 このレーザー光に当たらないようにしてください。  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
373  
Power consumption  
Product power consumption  
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
Mode  
Description  
Power consumption (Watts)  
Printing  
The product is generating hardcopy output from electronic inputs.  
760 (XM7155); 860 (XM7163); 960  
(XM7170)  
Copy  
The product is generating hardcopy output from hardcopy original  
820 (XM7155); 920 (XM7163); 1020  
(XM7170)  
documents.  
Scan  
The product is scanning hardcopy documents.  
140  
Ready  
The product is waiting for a print job.  
120 (Ready 1); 70 (Ready 2)  
Sleep Mode The product is in a highlevel energysaving mode.  
16  
Hibernate The product is in a lowlevel energysaving mode.  
0.7  
Off  
The product is plugged into an electrical outlet, but the power switch is 0  
turned off.  
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements. Instantaneous  
power draws may be substantially higher than the average.  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Sleep Mode  
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Sleep Mode. The Sleep Mode saves energy by lowering  
power consumption during extended periods of inactivity. The Sleep Mode is automatically engaged after this product  
is not used for a specified period of time, called the Sleep Mode Timeout.  
Factory default Sleep Mode Timeout for this product (in minutes):  
30  
By using the configuration menus, the Sleep Mode Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 180 minutes. Setting  
the Sleep ModeTimeout toa low value reduces energy consumption, but mayincrease theresponse timeof the product.  
Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response, but uses more energy.  
Hibernate Mode  
This product is designed with an ultralow power operating mode called Hibernate mode. When operating in Hibernate  
Mode, all other systems and devices are powered down safely.  
The Hibernate mode can be entered in any of the following methods:  
Using the Hibernate Timeout  
Using the Schedule Power modes  
Using the Sleep/Hibernate button  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
374  
Factory default Hibernate Timeout for this product in all countries or regions  
Disabled  
The amount of time the printer waits after a job is printed before it enters Hibernate mode can be modified between  
one hour and one month.  
Off mode  
If this product has an off mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product power  
consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.  
Total energy usage  
It is sometimes helpful to calculate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are provided in  
power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends in each mode in  
order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's energy usage.  
Industry Canada compliance statement  
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Standard  
ICES-003.  
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’industrie du Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux équipements  
pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.  
European Community (EC) directives conformity  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC, and  
1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic  
compatibility and safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits and on radio equipment  
and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Radio interference notice  
Warning  
This is a product that complies with the emission requirements of EN55022 Class A limits and immunity requirements  
of EN55024. This product is not intended to be used in residential/domestic environments.  
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in which case the user  
may be required to take adequate measures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
375  
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment  
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to products that contain telecommunication terminal  
equipment such as facsimile.  
Notice to users of the US telephone network: FCC requirements  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative Council  
for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the back of this equipment is a label that contains, among other information, a  
product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to your telephone  
company.  
This equipment uses the RJ-11C Universal Service Order Code (USOC) jack.  
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises’ wiring and telephone network must comply with the  
applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant telephone cord and modular plug is  
provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a compatible modular jack that is also compliant. See your  
setup documentation for more information.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a telephone  
line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most  
but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be  
connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact your local telephone company. For products approved  
after July 23, 2001, the REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX.  
The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point (for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products,  
the REN is shown separately on the label.  
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that  
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company will  
notify the customer as soon as possible. You will also be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC.  
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that could affect the  
operation of this equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to  
make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with this equipment, for repair or warranty information, contact Lexmark International, Inc.  
at www.lexmark.com or your Lexmark representative. If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone network, the  
telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.  
This equipment contains no user serviceable parts. For repair and warranty information, contact Lexmark International,  
Inc. See the previous paragraph for contact information.  
Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs. Contact the state public utility commission, public service  
commission, or corporation commission for information.  
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation of this  
equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm equipment,  
consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter's  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
376  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic  
device, including fax machines, to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a margin at the top or  
bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time itis sent and an identification  
of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message, and the telephone number of the sending  
machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or  
any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance transmission charges.)  
See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine.  
Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network  
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications. The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is  
an indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The terminus of  
an interface may consist of any combination of devices, subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of  
all the devices does not exceed five. The modem REN is located on the rear of the equipment on the product labeling.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter’s  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks.  
Avis réservé aux utilisateurs du réseau téléphonique du Canada  
Ce produit est conforme aux spécifications techniques d’Industrie Canada. Le numéro REN (ringer equivalence number :  
numéro d’équivalence de sonnerie) fournit une indication du nombre maximum de terminaux pouvant être connectés  
à l’interface téléphonique. En bout de ligne, le nombre d’appareils qui peuvent être connectés n’est pas directement  
limité, mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas dépasser cinq. Le numéro REN du modem est indiqué sur  
l’étiquette produit située à l’arrière de l’équipement.  
Les compagnies de téléphone constatent que les surtensions électriques, en particulier celles dues à la foudre,  
entraînent d'importants dégâts sur les terminaux privés connectés à des sources d’alimentation CA. Il s’agit-là d’un  
problème majeur d’échelle nationale. En conséquence, il vous est recommandé de brancher un parasurtenseur dans  
la prise de courant à laquelle l’équipement est connecté. Utilisez un parasurtenseur répondant à des caractéristiques  
nominales satisfaisantes et certifié par le laboratoire d’assureurs UL (Underwriter’s Laboratories), un autre laboratoire  
agréé de type NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory) ou un organisme de certification agréé dans votre région  
ou pays. Ceci prévient tout endommagement de l’équipement causé par les orages et autres surtensions électriques.  
Cet équipement utilise des prises de téléphone CA11A.  
Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network  
The following are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions. The grant of a telepermit for any item of terminal  
equipment indicates only that Telecom has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions for connection  
to its network. It indicates no endorsement of the product by Telecom, nor does it provide any sort of warranty. Above  
all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another item of telepermitted  
equipment of a different make or model, nor does it imply that any product is compatible with all of Telecom's network  
services.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
377  
This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Telecom's 111 Emergency Service.  
This equipment may not provide for the effective hand-over of a call to another device connected to the same line.  
This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Telecom  
customers.  
Some parameters required for compliance with Telecom's telepermit requirements are dependent on the equipment  
associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following limits for compliance  
to Telecom's specifications:  
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period for any single manual  
call initiation, and  
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt and the  
beginning of the next call attempt.  
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to different numbers are spaced such that there is not  
less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another.  
Using this product in Switzerland  
This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter (Lexmark part number 14B5109 or 80D1877) to be installed on any line  
which receives metering pulses in Switzerland. The Lexmark filter must be used, as metering pulses are present on all  
analog telephone lines in Switzerland.  
Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse  
Cet appareil nécessite l’utilisation d’un filtre de tonalité de facturation suisse (nº de référence Lexmark : 14B5109 ou  
80D1877) devant être installé sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse. Ce filtre doit être utilisé  
pour toute installation car ces impulsions existent sur toutes les lignes téléphoniques suisses.  
Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz  
Für dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Zählzeichenübertragung (Lexmark Teilenummer  
14B5109 oder 80D1877) für jede Leitung installiert werden, über die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte übertragen werden.  
Die Verwendung des Lexmark Filters ist obligatorisch, da in allen analogen Telefonleitungen in der Schweiz  
Zeitsteuertakte vorhanden sind.  
Uso del prodotto in Svizzera  
Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero, (codice Lexmark 14B5109 o 80D1877) da installare su tutte le  
linee che ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera. È necessario utilizzare il filtro Lexmark poiché gli impulsi remoti sono  
presenti su tutte le linee analogiche in Svizzera.  
Notice to Users in the European Union  
Products bearing the CE mark are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC,  
2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to  
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits and on radio  
equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
378  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Refer to the table at the end of the Notices section for further compliance information.  
Regulatory notices for wireless products  
This section contains the following regulatory information pertaining to wireless products that contain transmitters,  
for example, but not limited to, wireless network cards or proximity card readers.  
Modular component notice  
This product may contain the following modular component(s):  
Lexmark Regulatory Type/Model LEX-M01-005; FCC ID:IYLLEXM01005; IC:2376A-M01005  
Exposure to radio frequency radiation  
The radiated output power of this device is far below the radio frequency exposure limits of the FCC and other regulatory  
agencies. A minimum separation of 20 cm (8 inches) must be maintained between the antenna and any persons for  
this device to satisfy the RF exposure requirements of the FCC and other regulatory agencies.  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
This device complies with Industry Canada specification RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that  
may cause undesired operation of the device.  
This device has been designed to operate only with the antenna provided. Use of any other antenna is strictly prohibited  
per regulations of Industry Canada.  
To prevent radio interference to the licensed service, this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from  
windows to provide maximum shielding. Equipment (or its transmit antenna) that is installed outdoors is subject to  
licensing.  
The installer of this radio equipment must ensure that the antenna is located or pointed such that it does not emit RF  
fields in excess of Health Canada limits for the general population; consult Safety Code 6, obtainable from Health  
Canada's Web site www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
The term "IC:" before the certification/registration number only signifies that the Industry Canada technical  
specifications were met.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
379  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
Cet appareil est conforme à la norme RSS-210 d'Industry Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions  
suivantes :  
(1) cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d'interférences et (2) il doit accepter toute interférence reçue, y compris celles  
risquant d'altérer son fonctionnement.  
Cet appareil a été conçu pour fonctionner uniquement avec l'antenne fournie. L'utilisation de toute autre antenne est  
strictement interdite par la réglementation d'Industry Canada.  
En application des réglementations d'Industry Canada, l'utilisation d'une antenne de gain supérieur est strictement  
interdite.  
Pour empêcher toute interférence radio au service faisant l'objet d'une licence, cet appareil doit être utilisé à l'intérieur  
et loin des fenêtres afin de garantir une protection optimale.  
Si le matériel (ou son antenne d'émission) est installé à l'extérieur, il doit faire l'objet d'une licence.  
L'installateur de cet équipement radio doit veiller à ce que l'antenne soit implantée et dirigée de manière à n'émettre  
aucun champ HF dépassant les limites fixées pour l'ensemble de la population par Santé Canada. Reportez-vous au  
Code de sécurité 6 que vous pouvez consulter sur le site Web de Santé Canada www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
Le terme « IC » précédant le numéro de d'accréditation/inscription signifie simplement que le produit est conforme  
aux spécifications techniques d'Industry Canada.  
Notice to users in the European Union  
Products bearing the CE mark are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC,  
2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to  
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits, and on  
radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Products equipped with 2.4GHz Wireless LAN option are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council  
directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the  
Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain  
voltage limits and on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
380  
Operation is allowed in all EU and EFTA countries, but is restricted to indoor use only.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product may be used in the countries indicated in the table below.  
AT  
EL  
LI  
BE  
ES  
LT  
SE  
BG  
FI  
CH  
FR  
LV  
SK  
CY  
CZ  
DE  
IE  
DK  
IS  
EE  
IT  
HR  
MT  
TR  
HU  
NL  
UK  
LU  
SI  
NO  
PL  
PT  
RO  
Česky  
Společnost Lexmark International, Inc. tímto prohlašuje, že výrobek tento výrobek je ve shodě se základními  
požadavky a dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.  
Dansk  
Deutsch  
LexmarkInternational,Inc. erklærerherved, atdetteproduktoverholderdevæsentligekravogøvrige relevante  
krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Hiermit erklärt Lexmark International, Inc., dass sich das Gerät dieses Gerät in Übereinstimmung mit den  
grundlegenden Anforderungen und den übrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999/5/EG  
befindet.  
Ελληνική ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ Η LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC. ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ ΑΥΤΟ ΤΟ ΠΡΟΪΟΝ  
ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ  
ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.  
English  
Español  
Eesti  
Hereby, Lexmark International, Inc., declares that this type of equipment is in compliance with the  
essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.  
Por medio de la presente, Lexmark International, Inc. declara que este producto cumple con los requisitos  
esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999/5/CE.  
Käesolevaga kinnitab Lexmark International, Inc., et seade see toode vastab direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ  
põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele muudele asjakohastele sätetele.  
Suomi  
Lexmark International, Inc. vakuuttaa täten, että tämä tuote on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten  
ja muiden sitä koskevien direktiivin ehtojen mukainen.  
Français  
Magyar  
Íslenska  
Italiano  
Latviski  
Lietuvių  
Par la présente, Lexmark International, Inc. déclare que l'appareil ce produit est conforme aux exigences  
fondamentales et autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.  
Alulírott, Lexmark International, Inc. nyilatkozom, hogy a termék megfelel a vonatkozó alapvetõ  
követelményeknek és az 1999/5/EC irányelv egyéb elõírásainak.  
Hér með lýsir Lexmark International, Inc. yfir því að þessi vara er í samræmi við grunnkröfur og aðrar  
kröfur, sem gerðar eru í tilskipun 1999/5/EC.  
Con la presente Lexmark International, Inc. dichiara che questo questo prodotto è conforme ai requisiti  
essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.  
Ar šo Lexmark International, Inc. deklarē, ka šis izstrādājums atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām  
prasībām un citiem ar to saistītajiem noteikumiem.  
Šiuo Lexmark International, Inc. deklaruoja, kad šis produktas atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas  
1999/5/EB direktyvos nuostatas.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
381  
Malti  
Bil-preżenti, Lexmark International, Inc., jiddikjara li dan il-prodott huwa konformi mal-ħtiġijiet  
essenzjali u ma dispożizzjonijiet oħrajn relevanti li jinsabu fid-Direttiva 1999/5/KE.  
Nederlands Hierbijverklaart Lexmark International, Inc. dat hettoestel ditproductinovereenstemmingismetdeessentiële  
eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.  
Norsk  
Lexmark International, Inc. erklærer herved at dette produktet er i samsvar med de grunnleggende krav og  
øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Polski  
Niniejszym Lexmark International, Inc. oświadcza, że niniejszy produkt jest zgodny z zasadniczymi  
wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.  
Português A Lexmark International Inc. declara que este este produto está conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras  
disposições da Diretiva 1999/5/CE.  
Slovensky Lexmark International, Inc. týmto vyhlasuje, že tento produkt spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky  
príslušné ustanovenia smernice 1999/5/ES.  
Slovensko Lexmark International, Inc. izjavlja, da je ta izdelek v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi  
relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.  
Svenska  
Härmed intygar Lexmark International, Inc. att denna produkt står i överensstämmelse med de väsentliga  
egenskapskrav och övriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgår av direktiv 1999/5/EG.  
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,  
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER PRINTERS  
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY  
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the country-  
specific warranty information that came with your product.  
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale, from  
Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.”  
Limited warranty  
Lexmark warrants that this product:  
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts  
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship  
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for repair  
or replacement (at Lexmark's option).  
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the product  
for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or option with the  
product.  
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to that user  
for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that  
user.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
382  
Limited warranty service  
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12 months later  
provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with the printer shall end  
earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser Units, Transfer/Transport  
Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is available are substantially consumed  
when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance” message for such item.  
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to deliver  
your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location.  
You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the Lexmark designated location.  
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of the  
Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.  
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.  
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a repair not  
included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal obligations, restrictions,  
liens, and encumbrances.  
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the latest  
version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized products, supplies,  
parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized use of genuine Lexmark  
products will not be impacted.  
Before youpresentthisproduct for warranty service, removeallprint cartridges, programs, data, andremovable storage  
media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).  
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area contact  
Lexmark on the World Wide Web.  
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer covered  
by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.  
Extent of limited warranty  
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of prints  
produced by any product.  
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:  
—Modification or unauthorized attachments  
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance  
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment  
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer  
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle  
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications  
—Refurbishment, repair, refilling or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts  
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark  
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS OR  
REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH  
RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
383  
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT  
MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO  
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES,  
AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.  
Limitation of liability  
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance or  
nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover actual  
damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.  
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the product  
that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to real  
property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.  
This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any  
claim by you based on a third party claim.  
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's and its  
Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers are intended  
beneficiaries of this limitation.  
Additional rights  
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or limitation  
of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not apply to you.  
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.  
Patent acknowledgment  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Elliptic Curve Cryptography (ECC) Cipher Suites for Transport  
Layer Security (TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for TLS Elliptic Curve Cipher Suites with SHA-256/382 and AES Galois  
Counter Mode (GCM) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights(IPR) Disclosure ofCerticom Corp. atthe IETF for TLS Suite B Profile for Transport Layer Security (TLS) implemented  
in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Addition of the Camellia Cipher Suites to Transport Layer Security  
(TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of certain patents in this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the  
Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for AES-CCM ECC Cipher Suites for TLS  
implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for IKE and IKEv2 Authentication Using the Eliptic Curve Digital  
Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) implemented in the product or service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
384  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Suite B Cryptographic Suites for IPSec implemented in the  
product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Algorithms for Internet Key Exchange version 1 (IKEv1)  
implemented in the product or service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
385  
Index  
administrator settings  
Embedded Web Server 269  
advanced options  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
Numerics  
2100sheet tray  
loading 74  
type name] load [orientation] 300  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
size] load [orientation] 300  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
type] [paper size] load  
[orientation] 301  
Check tray [x] connection 301  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 320  
checking status of parts and  
supplies 255  
checking the status of parts and  
supplies 255  
checking the virtual display  
using the Embedded Web  
checking virtual display  
using the Embedded Web  
cleaning  
exterior of the printer 251  
scanner glass 252  
cleaning the printer 251  
Close door or insert cartridge 301  
Close finisher side door 301  
Close flatbed cover and load  
originals if restarting job  
[2yy.xx] 301  
Close front door 302  
Close top access cover 302  
collate  
copy options 118  
collating copies 114  
Complex page, some data may not  
have printed [39] 302  
compressed images appear on  
prints 335  
copy options 119  
550sheet tray  
email options 126  
installing 49  
fax options 151  
FTP options 159  
answering machine  
setting up 129  
AppleTalk menu 180  
applications  
understanding 23  
attaching cables 52  
available internal options 29  
avoiding jams 95  
Symbols  
[x]page jam, open upper rear  
door. [202] 281  
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder.  
[x]page jam, lift front cover to  
remove cartridge. [200–201] 277  
[x]page jam, open automatic  
feeder top cover. [28y.xx] 294  
[x]page jam, open mailbox rear  
door. Leave paper in bin.  
[4yy.xx] 291  
avoiding paper jams 272  
B
Bin Setup menu 172  
blocking junk faxes 148  
buttons, printer control panel 16  
buttons, touch screen  
using 19  
[x]page jam, open tray [x].  
[x]page jam, open upper and lower  
rear door. [231–234] 283  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open  
stapler door. Leave paper in bin.  
[4yy.xx] 295  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open  
stapler door. Leave paper in bin.  
[455–457] 296  
C
cables  
Ethernet 52  
canceling  
[x]page jam, remove standard bin  
print job, from computer 106  
canceling a print job  
from a computer 106  
from the printer control  
canceling an e-mail 124  
cannot open Embedded Web  
Card Copy  
setting up 24  
card stock  
loading 81  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to clear  
duplex. [235–239] 288  
A
accessing the Embedded Web  
Active NIC menu 175  
adapter plug 137  
ADF  
confidential data  
information on securing 250  
confidential jobs  
modifying print settings 105  
confidential print jobs 104  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 104  
printing from Windows 104  
Confidential Print menu 190  
copying using 108  
adjusting brightness  
Embedded Web Server 244  
printer display 244  
adjusting copy quality 113  
adjusting display brightness 244  
adjusting Sleep mode 243  
adjusting toner darkness 100  
Cartridge low [88.xy] 300  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy] 300  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 300  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
string] load [orientation] 300  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
386  
Configuration change, some held  
jobs were not restored [57] 302  
configuration information  
wireless network 58  
Configure MP menu 161  
configuring  
supply notifications, imaging  
supply notifications, maintenance  
copy options  
advanced options 119  
darkness 118  
Save As Shortcut 119  
sides (duplex) 118  
copy quality  
adjusting 113  
copy screen  
copying on transparencies 109  
creating a fax destination shortcut  
using the Embedded Web  
creating an FTP shortcut  
using the Embedded Web  
Custom Bin Names menu 171  
Custom Names menu 170  
custom paper type  
supply notifications, toner  
cartridge 270  
configuring email settings 120  
configuring port settings 61  
configuring supply notifications 270  
connecting printer to distinctive  
ring service 142  
connecting to a wireless network  
using PIN (Personal Identification  
Number) method 59  
using Push Button Configuration  
method 59  
using the Embedded Web  
content source 118  
content type 118  
options 117, 118  
assigning 89  
custom paper type name  
creating 88  
Custom Scan Sizes menu 171  
Custom Type [x]  
changing name 88  
Custom Types menu 170  
customer support  
contacting 367  
Copy Settings menu 202  
copy troubleshooting  
copier does not respond 353  
partial document or photo  
poor copy quality 354  
poor scanned image quality 362  
scanner unit does not  
D
darkness  
copying  
copy options 118  
adding an overlay message 116  
adjusting quality 113  
canceling a copy job 117  
collating copies 114  
creating shortcuts using the  
printer control panel 110  
custom job 115  
different paper sizes 111  
enlarging 113  
inserting a header or footer 116  
multiple pages on one sheet 115  
on both sides of the paper  
(duplexing) 112  
on letterhead 110  
on transparencies 109  
photos 109  
placing separator sheets between  
quick copy 108  
email options 125  
using wireless setup wizard 59  
conservation settings  
brightness, adjusting 244  
conserving supplies 241  
EcoMode 242  
fax options 150  
scan options 157  
date and time, fax  
setting 143  
daylight saving time, setting 143  
Default Source menu 161  
Defective flash detected [51] 302  
delayed send  
fax options 150  
device and network settings  
information  
Hibernate mode 244  
Quiet Mode 242  
Sleep mode 243  
conserving supplies 241  
contacting customer support 367  
content  
email settings 125  
erasing 248  
content source  
different paper sizes, copying 111  
Digital Subscriber Line (DSL)  
fax setup 133  
digital telephone service  
fax setup 136  
directory list  
printing 106  
email settings 125  
fax options 150  
content type  
email settings 125  
fax options 150  
control panel, printer 16  
indicator light 16  
Sleep button light 16  
controller board  
accessing 30  
copies  
copy options 118  
copy job, canceling  
using the ADF 117  
using the scanner glass 117  
reducing 113  
selecting a tray 111  
to a different size 111  
using the ADF 108  
using the scanner glass 109  
copying different paper sizes 111  
copying multiple pages on one  
sheet 115  
Disk full 62 302  
Disk full, scan job canceled 303  
Disk must be formatted for use in  
this device 303  
disk wiping 248  
Disk Wiping menu 191  
display troubleshooting  
printer display is blank 321  
copying on both sides of the paper  
(duplexing) 112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
387  
display, printer control panel 16  
adjusting brightness 244  
disposing of printer hard disk 247  
distinctive ring service, fax  
connecting to 142  
documents, printing  
from Macintosh 100  
from Windows 100  
erasing nonvolatile memory 248  
erasing printer hard disk  
memory 248  
erasing volatile memory 247  
Error reading USB drive. Remove  
USB. 303  
Error reading USB hub. Remove  
Ethernet network  
preparing to set up for Ethernet  
printing 56  
Ethernet network setup  
using Macintosh 56  
using Windows 56  
Ethernet networking  
Macintosh 56  
Windows 56  
Ethernet port 52  
Ethernet setup  
email, sending  
using a shortcut number 122  
using the address book 123  
emailing  
adding message line 123  
adding subject line 123  
changing output file type 123  
configuring email settings 120  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 121  
creating shortcuts using the  
printer control panel 121  
setting up email function 120  
using a shortcut number 122  
using the address book 123  
using the printer control  
DSL filter 133  
duplexing 112  
E
EcoMode setting 242  
Edit Security Setups menu 188  
embedded solutions information  
erasing 248  
Embedded Web Server  
accessing 22  
administrator settings 269  
checking the status of parts 255  
checking the status of  
supplies 255  
creating a fax destination  
shortcut 146  
creating an FTP shortcut 152  
creating email shortcuts 121  
initial fax setup 128  
F
preparing for an 56  
exporting a configuration  
using the Embedded Web  
EXT port 52  
exterior of the printer  
cleaning 251  
factory defaults  
restoring 271  
fax  
sending at a scheduled time 145  
fax and email functions  
setting up 360  
email  
fax and email functions are not set  
canceling 124  
modifying confidential print  
settings 105  
fax log  
email alerts  
low supply levels 269  
paper jam 269  
networking settings 269  
problem accessing 366  
scanning to a computer using 155  
setting up email alerts 269  
Embedded Web Server  
Administrator's Guide  
where to find 250, 269  
Empty the hole punch box 303  
emptying the hole punch box 254  
encrypting the printer hard  
disk 249  
viewing 147  
Fax memory full 303  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup)  
fax name, setting 142  
fax number, setting 142  
fax options  
advanced options 151  
content source 150  
content type 150  
darkness 150  
delayed send 150  
page setup 150  
resolution 149  
scan preview 151  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 303  
fax port 52  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 304  
fax setup  
setting up 269  
email function  
setting up 120  
email options  
advanced options 126  
darkness 125  
message 124  
original size 124  
page setup 126  
recipient(s) 124  
resolution 125  
Save As Shortcut 125  
send as 125  
subject 124  
email screen  
enlarging a copy 113  
envelopes  
loading 81  
tips on using 90  
environmental settings  
conserving supplies 241  
display brightness, adjusting 244  
EcoMode 242  
options 124, 126  
Email Settings menu 214  
email shortcuts, creating  
using the Embedded Web  
Hibernate mode 244  
Quiet Mode 242  
Sleep mode 243  
countryor regionspecific 137  
digital telephone service 136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
388  
DSL connection 133  
standard telephone line  
connection 129  
flash drive  
home screen buttons and icons  
description 17  
HTML menu 238  
printing from 102  
Flash Drive menu 222  
flash drives  
VoIP 134  
Fax Station Name not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 304  
Fax Station Number not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 304  
fax troubleshooting  
caller ID is not shown 356  
can receive but not send  
can send but not receive  
cannot send or receive a fax 356  
received fax has poor print  
quality 360  
supported file types 103  
font sample list  
printing 106  
Forms and Favorites  
setting up 23  
forwarding faxes 149  
FTP  
I
icons on the home screen  
hiding 22  
showing 22  
Image menu 239  
imaging unit  
ordering 257  
FTP options 157  
FTP address  
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 304  
Imaging unit nearly low [84.xy] 304  
Imaging unit very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 304  
importing a configuration  
using the Embedded Web  
Incompatible output bin [x]  
Incompatible tray [x] [59] 305  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper  
source] [34] 305  
creating shortcuts using the  
printer control panel 153  
FTP address, scanning to  
using a shortcut number 154  
using the printer control  
FTP options  
advanced options 159  
faxing  
blocking junk faxes 148  
canceling a fax job 148  
changing resolution 147  
configuring the printer to observe  
daylight saving time 143  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 146  
creating shortcuts using the  
printer control panel 146  
distinctive ring service 142  
fax setup 128  
forwarding faxes 149  
holding faxes 148  
making a fax lighter or darker 147  
sending a fax at a scheduled  
time 145  
FTP Settings menu 218  
individual settings information  
erasing 248  
initial fax setup 128  
G
General Settings menu 193  
green settings  
using the Embedded Web  
EcoMode 242  
Hibernate mode 244  
Quiet Mode 242  
Insert hole punch box 305  
Insert staple cartridge 305  
Insert Tray [x] 305  
inserting a header or footer 116  
Install bin [x] 305  
Install duplex 306  
Install Tray [x] 306  
H
held jobs 104  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 104  
printing from Windows 104  
Help menu 239  
Hibernate mode  
hiding icons on the home screen 22  
holding faxes 148  
hole punch box  
emptying 254  
home screen  
customizing 22  
hiding icons 22  
sending using the printer control  
installing an Internal Solutions  
Port 37  
setting the date and time 143  
setting the fax number 142  
setting the outgoing fax name 142  
viewing a fax log 147  
FCC notices 370, 375, 378  
file name  
scan options 157  
finding more information about the  
printer 10  
finding printer IP address 21  
finisher  
finishing features 97  
supported paper sizes 97  
finisher features 97  
Finishing menu 229  
firmware card 29  
installing an optional card 35  
installing internal options  
order of installation 49  
installing printer hard disk 42  
installing printer on a network  
Ethernet networking 56  
installing printer software  
adding options 55  
installing printer software  
(Windows) 54  
Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment operation  
showing icons 22  
home screen applications  
configuring 23  
finding information 23  
Insufficient memory to collate job  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
389  
Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature [35] 307  
Insufficient memory, some Held  
Jobs were deleted [37] 307  
Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored [37] 307  
internal options 29  
LINE port 52  
linking trays 87, 89  
Memory full, cannot print  
Memory full, cannot send  
menu settings page  
printing 64  
menus  
Active NIC 175  
Bin Setup 172  
Confidential Print 190  
Configure MP 161  
Copy Settings 202  
Custom Bin Names 171  
Custom Names 170  
Custom Scan Sizes 171  
Custom Types 170  
Default Source 161  
diagram of 160  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 307  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
type name] [paper orientation] 307  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 307  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 308  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 308  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom  
type name] [paper orientation] 308  
Load Manual Feeder with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 308  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 308  
internal print server  
troubleshooting 322  
Internal Solutions Port  
changing port settings 61  
installing 37  
troubleshooting 323  
IP address of computer  
finding 21  
IP address, printer  
finding 21  
IPv6 menu 179  
Disk Wiping 191  
Edit Security Setups 188  
Email Settings 214  
J
Load staples 309  
loading  
jams  
avoiding 272  
locating jam areas 275  
locations 275  
numbers 275  
jams, clearing  
behind rear door 283  
in automatic document feeder top  
cover 294  
in mailbox rear door 291  
in manual feeder 290  
in staple finisher 296  
in stapler door 295  
in tray [x] 289  
inside the printer 277  
rear door 281  
2100sheet tray 74  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) 206  
Finishing 229  
card stock 81  
envelopes 81  
Flash Drive 222  
FTP Settings 218  
General Settings 193  
HTML 238  
Image 239  
letterhead in 2100sheet tray 74  
letterhead in multipurpose  
letterhead in trays 65  
multipurpose feeder 81  
optional 550sheet tray 65  
standard 550sheet tray 65  
transparencies 81  
loading letterhead  
paper orientation 91  
IPv6 179  
Job Accounting 232  
Miscellaneous Security  
Settings 189  
Network [x] 175  
Network Card 177  
Network Reports 177  
Paper Loading 169  
Paper Size/Type 162  
Paper Texture 165  
Paper Weight 167  
Parallel [x] 182  
PCL Emul 235  
PDF 234  
PostScript 235  
Quality 231  
Reports 174  
M
standard bin jam 287  
Job Accounting menu 232  
maintenance kit  
ordering 256  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy] 309  
Maintenance kit nearly low  
[80.xy] 309  
Maintenance kit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 309  
making copies using paper from  
selected tray 111  
memory  
types installed on printer 247  
memory card 29  
L
labels, paper  
letterhead  
copying on 110  
loading, 2100sheet tray 74  
loading, multipurpose  
loading, trays 65, 91  
light, indicator 16  
line filter 133  
Security Audit Log 191  
Serial [x] 184  
Set Date/Time 192  
Settings 227  
installing 33  
Memory full [38] 309  
SMTP Setup 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
390  
Standard Network 175  
paper characteristics 92  
paper feed troubleshooting  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 326  
paper jams  
avoiding 272  
paper jams, clearing  
behind rear door 283  
in automatic document feeder top  
in mailbox rear door 291  
in manual feeder 290  
in stapler door 295  
in tray [x] 289  
inside the printer 277  
standard bin jam 287  
upper rear door 281  
Paper Loading menu 169  
paper size  
O
Standard USB 181  
Substitute Size 165  
TCP/IP 177  
Universal Setup 172  
Wireless 179  
menus diagram 160  
message  
email options 124  
Miscellaneous Security Settings  
optional 550sheet tray  
loading 65  
optional card  
installing 35  
options  
550sheet tray, installing 49  
firmware cards 29  
Internal Solutions Port,  
installing 37  
memory card 29, 33  
printer hard disk, installing 42  
printer hard disk, removing 47  
updating in printer driver 55  
options, copy screen  
copy from 117  
mobile device  
printing from 101  
moving the printer 11, 267, 268  
Multi Send  
adding a profile 25  
setting up 25  
multipurpose feeder  
loading 81  
MyShortcut  
options, touchscreen  
copy 117  
email 124, 126  
ordering  
setting 65  
Paper Size/Type menu 162  
paper sizes  
supported by the printer 95  
Paper Texture menu 165  
paper type  
imaging unit 257  
maintenance kit 256  
staple cartridges 258  
ordering supplies  
toner cartridge 256  
organizing cables 52  
original size  
email options 124  
scan options 157  
output file type  
about 25  
N
Network [x] menu 175  
Network [x] software error  
setting 65  
paper types  
supported by printer 96  
Paper Weight menu 167  
paper weights  
supported by printer 96  
Parallel [x] menu 182  
Parallel port [x] disabled [56] 311  
parts  
checking status 255  
checking, from printer control  
checking, using the Embedded  
using genuine Lexmark 256  
PCL Emul menu 235  
PDF menu 234  
Personal Identification Number  
method  
using 59  
phone splitter 134  
photos  
Network Card menu 177  
Network Reports menu 177  
network settings  
Embedded Web Server 269  
network setup page  
printing 64  
Networking Guide  
changing 123  
P
page setup  
where to find 269  
email options 126  
fax options 150  
scan options 158  
paper  
characteristics 92  
different sizes, copying 111  
letterhead 93  
preprinted forms 93  
recycled 93  
saving 115  
selecting 93  
storing 92, 95  
unacceptable 93  
Universal size setting 65  
using recycled 241  
Paper changes needed 311  
No analog phone line connected to  
modem, fax is disabled. 310  
noise emission levels 370  
NonLexmark [supply type], see  
User’s Guide [33.xy] 310  
nonvolatile memory 247  
erasing 248  
Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources [52] 310  
number of remaining pages  
estimate 256  
copying 109  
placing separator sheets between  
copies 114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
391  
port settings  
configuring 61  
Large jobs do not collate 329  
multiplelanguage PDF files do not  
print 329  
[x]page jam, open tray [x].  
PostScript menu 235  
power cord socket 52  
preparing to set up the printer on  
an Ethernet network 56  
print irregularities 341  
print job  
[x]page jam, open upper and  
paper curl 339  
lower rear door. [231–234] 283  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open  
stapler door. Leave paper in bin.  
[4yy.xx] 295  
paper frequently jams 325  
print job takes longer than  
expected 332  
tray linking does not work 333  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 333  
[x]page jam, remove paper, open  
stapler door. Leave paper in bin.  
[455–457] 296  
canceling, from computer 106  
print quality  
cleaning the scanner glass 252  
print quality troubleshooting  
blank pages 339  
characters have jagged edges 334  
clipped pages or images 334  
compressed images appear on  
prints 335  
gray background on prints 336  
horizontal voids appear on  
prints 337  
print irregularities 341  
print is too dark 342  
printer  
basic model 13  
[x]page jam, remove standard bin  
finishing features 97  
fully configured 13  
minimum clearances 11  
selecting a location 11  
shipping 268  
printer configurations 13  
printer control panel 16  
factory defaults, restoring 271  
indicator light 16  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to  
clear duplex. [235–239] 288  
Cartridge low [88.xy] 300  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy] 300  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 300  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
string] load [orientation] 300  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
type name] load  
print is too light 344  
printer is printing solid black  
pages 340  
repeating defects appear on  
prints 345  
Sleep button light 16  
Printer had to restart. Last job may  
be incomplete. 311  
printer hard disk  
[orientation] 300  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
size] load [orientation] 300  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
type] [paper size] load  
disposing of 247  
shadow images appear on  
prints 346  
skewed print 346  
streaked horizontal lines appear  
on prints 347  
streaked vertical lines 348  
toner fog or background shading  
appears on prints 349  
toner rubs off 350  
toner specks appear on prints 350  
transparency print quality is  
poor 351  
uneven print density 351  
white streaks 351  
print troubleshooting  
envelope seals when printing 327  
error reading flash drive 327  
held jobs do not print 326  
incorrect characters print 328  
incorrect margins on prints 338  
jammed pages are not  
reprinted 325  
encrypting 249  
installing 42  
removing 47  
wiping 248  
printer hard disk encryption 249  
printer hard disk memory  
erasing 248  
printer information  
where to find 10  
printer IP address  
finding 21  
[orientation] 301  
Check tray [x] connection 301  
Close door or insert cartridge 301  
Close finisher side door 301  
Close flatbed cover and load  
originals if restarting job  
[2yy.xx] 301  
Close front door 302  
Close top access cover 302  
Complex page, some data may not  
have printed [39] 302  
Configuration change, some held  
jobs were not restored [57] 302  
Defective flash detected [51] 302  
Disk full 62 302  
Disk full, scan job canceled 303  
Disk must be formatted for use in  
this device 303  
Disk near full. Securely clearing  
disk space. 303  
Empty the hole punch box 303  
Error reading USB drive. Remove  
USB. 303  
Error reading USB hub. Remove  
printer is printing blank pages 339  
printer messages  
[x]page jam, open upper rear  
door. [202] 281  
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder.  
[x]page jam, lift front cover to  
remove cartridge. [200–  
[x]page jam, open automatic  
feeder top cover. [28y.xx] 294  
[x]page jam, open mailbox rear  
door. Leave paper in bin.  
[4yy.xx] 291  
job prints from wrong tray 328  
job prints on wrong paper 328  
jobs do not print 330  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
392  
Fax memory full 303  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 308  
Load Manual Feeder with [custom  
type name] [paper  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 313  
Replace cartridge, printer region  
mismatch [42.xy] 313  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 314  
Replace jammed originals if  
restarting job. 314  
Replace last scanned page and  
jammed originals if restarting  
job. 314  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 303  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system  
administrator. 304  
Fax Station Name not set up.  
Contact system  
administrator. 304  
Fax Station Number not set up.  
Contact system  
orientation] 308  
Load Manual Feeder with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 308  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 308  
Load staples 309  
administrator. 304  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy] 309  
Maintenance kit nearly low  
[80.xy] 309  
Maintenance kit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 309  
Replace maintenance kit, 0  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 315  
Replace missing fuser [80.xx] 315  
Replace separator pad 315  
Replace unsupported cartridge  
[32.xy] 315  
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 304  
Imaging unit nearly low  
[84.xy] 304  
Imaging unit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[84.xy] 304  
Memory full [38] 309  
Incompatible output bin [x]  
Incompatible tray [x] [59] 305  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper  
source] [34] 305  
Insert hole punch box 305  
Insert staple cartridge 305  
Insert Tray [x] 305  
Memory full, cannot print  
Memory full, cannot send  
Network [x] software error  
Replace unsupported imaging unit  
[32.xy] 315  
Replace wiper 315  
Restore held jobs? 315  
Scan document too long 316  
Scanner automatic feeder cover  
open 316  
Scanner disabled by admin  
Scanner disabled. Contact system  
administrator if problem persists.  
Scanner jam, remove all originals  
from the scanner [2yy.xx] 316  
Scanner jam, remove jammed  
originals from the scanner  
[2yy.xx] 316  
Scanner maintenance required  
soon, use ADF Kit [80] 316  
Serial option [x] error [54] 316  
Serial port [x] disabled [56] 317  
Some held jobs were not  
restored 317  
No analog phone line connected  
to modem, fax is disabled. 310  
NonLexmark [supply type], see  
User’s Guide [33.xy] 310  
Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources [52] 310  
Paper changes needed 311  
Parallel port [x] disabled [56] 311  
Printer had to restart. Last job  
may be incomplete. 311  
Reattach bin [x] 311  
Reattach bins [x] – [y] 312  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
cartridge [31.xy] 312  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
imaging unit [31.xy] 312  
Remove defective disk [61] 312  
Remove packaging material, [area  
Install bin [x] 305  
Install duplex 306  
Install Tray [x] 306  
Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment operation  
Insufficient memory to collate job  
Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature [35] 307  
Insufficient memory, some Held  
Jobs were deleted [37] 307  
Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 307  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
type name [paper  
Standard network software error  
Standard USB port disabled  
Remove paper from [linked set bin  
orientation] 307  
Remove paper from all bins 313  
Remove paper from bin [x] 313  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 313  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 313  
Supply needed to complete  
job 317  
Too many bins attached [58] 317  
Too many disks installed [58] 318  
Too many flash options installed  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 307  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 308  
Too many trays attached [58] 318  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
393  
Tray [x] paper size  
unsupported 318  
Unformatted flash detected  
Unsupported camera mode,  
unplug camera and change  
mode 318  
Unsupported disk 319  
Unsupported option in slot [x]  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
USB port [x] disabled [56] 319  
Weblink server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 319  
printer options troubleshooting  
internal option is not  
detected 322  
internal print server 322  
Internal Solutions Port 323  
tray problems 323  
USB/parallel interface card 324  
printer parts  
controller board 30  
printer problems, solving basic 320  
printer security  
information on 250  
printer software, installing  
(Windows) 54  
printing  
canceling, from printer control  
directory list 106  
printing from a mobile device 101  
printing slows down 330  
publications  
where to find 10  
Push Button Configuration method  
using 59  
Replace cartridge, printer region  
mismatch [42.xy] 313  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 314  
Replace jammed originals if  
restarting job. 314  
Replace last scanned page and  
jammed originals if restarting  
job. 314  
Replace maintenance kit, 0  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 315  
Replace missing fuser [80.xx] 315  
Replace separator pad 315  
Replace unsupported cartridge  
[32.xy] 315  
Replace unsupported imaging unit  
[32.xy] 315  
Replace wiper 315  
replacing a staple cartridge 266  
replacing supplies  
staple cartridge 266  
replacing the toner  
reports  
viewing 269  
Reports menu 174  
reserve print jobs 104  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 104  
printing from Windows 104  
resolution  
Q
Quality menu 231  
Quiet Mode 242  
R
Reattach bin [x] 311  
Reattach bins [x] – [y] 312  
recipient(s)  
email options 124  
recycled paper  
recycling  
Lexmark packaging 245  
Lexmark products 245  
toner cartridges 245  
reducing a copy 113  
reducing noise 242  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
cartridge [31.xy] 312  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
imaging unit [31.xy] 312  
Remote Operator Panel  
setting up 27  
Remove defective disk [61] 312  
Remove packaging material, [area  
Remove paper from [linked set bin  
Remove paper from all bins 313  
Remove paper from bin [x] 313  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 313  
removing printer hard disk 47  
repeat print jobs 104  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 104  
printing from Windows 104  
repeating defects appear on  
prints 345  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 313  
email options 125  
font sample list 106  
forms 100  
fax options 149  
scan options 157  
resolution, fax  
changing 147  
Restore held jobs? 315  
restoring factory default  
settings 271  
RJ11 adapter 137  
from a mobile device 101  
from flash drive 102  
from Macintosh 100  
from Windows 100  
menu settings page 64  
network setup page 64  
printing a directory list 106  
printing a document 100  
printing a font sample list 106  
printing a menu settings page 64  
printing a network setup page 64  
printing confidential and other held  
jobs  
S
safety information 8, 9  
Save As Shortcut  
copy options 119  
email options 125  
scan options 157  
saving paper 115  
Scan document too long 316  
scan options  
from a Macintosh computer 104  
from Windows 104  
printing forms 100  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 313  
printing from a flash drive 102  
darkness 157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
394  
file name 157  
original size 157  
page setup 158  
quick copy 108  
paper type 65  
TCP/IP address 177  
setting the fax number 142  
to a computer 156  
to a computer using the  
Embedded Web Server 155  
to an FTP address 153, 154  
scanning to a computer 156  
using the Embedded Web  
scanning to a flash drive 156  
scanning to an FTP address  
creating shortcuts using the  
computer 152  
resolution 157  
setting the outgoing fax name 142  
setting Universal paper size 65  
setting up email alerts 269  
setting up fax  
countryor regionspecific 137  
digital telephone service 136  
DSL connection 133  
standard telephone line  
connection 129  
Save As Shortcut 157  
Scan Preview 158  
send as 157  
Scan Preview  
scan options 158  
scan preview  
fax options 151  
scan screen  
content source 158  
content type 158  
Scan to Computer  
setting up 156  
Scan to Network  
setting up 26  
using a shortcut number 154  
using the address book 154  
using the printer control  
scanning to network  
destinations 152  
security  
modifying confidential print  
settings 105  
Security Audit Log menu 191  
security settings information  
erasing 248  
security Web page  
where to find 250  
VoIP connection 134  
setting up fax and email  
functions 360  
setting up serial printing 62  
setting up the printer  
on an Ethernet network  
(Macintosh only) 56  
on an Ethernet network (Windows  
Settings menu 227  
shipping the printer 268  
shortcuts, creating  
copy screen 110  
scan troubleshooting  
cannot scan from a computer 362  
partial document or photo  
scan job was not successful 363  
scanner unit does not  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 364  
scanner  
Automatic document feeder  
(ADF) 15  
email 121  
selecting a location for the  
printer 11  
selecting paper 93  
send as  
fax destination 146  
FTP address 153  
FTP destination 152  
showing icons on the home  
email options 125  
functions 14  
scan options 157  
sides (duplex)  
scanner glass 15  
Scanner automatic feeder cover  
open 316  
sending a fax 144  
sending a fax using the printer  
control panel 143  
copy options 118  
Sleep mode  
adjusting 243  
Scanner disabled by admin  
Scanner disabled. Contact system  
administrator if problem persists.  
scanner glass  
cleaning 252  
copying using 109  
Scanner jam, remove all originals  
from the scanner [2yy.xx] 316  
Scanner jam, remove jammed  
originals from the scanner  
[2yy.xx] 316  
sending an email using the printer  
SMTP Setup menu 187  
Some held jobs were not  
restored 317  
control panel 122  
sending fax  
using shortcuts 144  
using the address book 145  
sending fax at a scheduled  
time 145  
sending fax using the address  
book 145  
Serial [x] menu 184  
Serial option [x] error [54] 316  
Serial port [x] disabled [56] 317  
serial printing  
standard 550sheet tray  
loading 65  
Standard Network menu 175  
Standard network software error  
standard tray  
loading 65  
Standard USB menu 181  
Standard USB port disabled  
Scanner maintenance required  
soon, use ADF Kit [80] 316  
scanning  
setting up 62  
Set Date/Time menu 192  
setting  
staple cartridge  
replacing 266  
staple cartridges  
ordering 258  
from a flash drive 156  
paper size 65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
395  
staple jams, clearing  
in staple finisher 296  
statement of volatility 247  
status of parts  
transparencies 92  
tips on using envelopes 90  
tips on using letterhead 91  
toner cartridge  
can send but not receive  
cannot send or receive a fax 356  
received fax has poor print  
quality 360  
checking 255  
ordering 256  
status of supplies  
checking 255  
storing  
toner cartridges  
recycling 245  
troubleshooting, paper feed  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 326  
supplies 258  
storing print jobs 104  
streaked horizontal lines appear on  
prints 347  
streaked vertical lines appear on  
prints 348  
streaks appear 351  
subject and message information  
adding to email 123  
Substitute Size menu 165  
supplies  
checking status 255  
checking, from printer control  
toner darkness  
adjusting 100  
troubleshooting, print  
envelope seals when printing 327  
error reading flash drive 327  
held jobs do not print 326  
incorrect characters print 328  
incorrect margins on prints 338  
jammed pages are not  
reprinted 325  
job prints from wrong tray 328  
job prints on wrong paper 328  
jobs do not print 330  
Large jobs do not collate 329  
multiplelanguage PDF files do not  
print 329  
Too many bins attached [58] 317  
Too many disks installed [58] 318  
Too many flash options installed  
Too many trays attached [58] 318  
touch screen  
buttons 19  
transparencies  
copying on 109  
loading 81  
Tray [x] paper size  
unsupported 318  
paper curl 339  
checking, using the Embedded  
conserving 241  
trays  
linking 87, 89  
unlinking 87, 89  
paper frequently jams 325  
print job takes longer than  
expected 332  
storing 258  
troubleshooting  
an application error has  
occurred 366  
cannot open Embedded Web  
tray linking does not work 333  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 333  
troubleshooting, print quality  
blank pages 339  
using genuine Lexmark 256  
using recycled paper 241  
supplies, ordering  
imaging unit 257  
maintenance kit 256  
staple cartridges 258  
toner cartridge 256  
Supply needed to complete job 317  
supply notifications  
configuring 270  
supported flash drives 103  
supported paper sizes 95  
supported paper types 96  
supported paper weights 96  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 320  
characters have jagged edges 334  
clipped pages or images 334  
compressed images appear on  
prints 335  
gray background on prints 336  
horizontal voids appear on  
prints 337  
print irregularities 341  
print is too dark 342  
print is too light 344  
printer is printing solid black  
pages 340  
repeating defects appear on  
prints 345  
shadow images appear on  
prints 346  
skewed print 346  
fax and email functions are not  
set up 360  
solving basic printer  
problems 320  
the scanner does not respond 365  
troubleshooting, copy  
copier does not respond 353  
partial document or photo  
poor copy quality 354  
poor scanned image quality 362  
scanner unit does not  
troubleshooting, display  
printer display is blank 321  
troubleshooting, fax  
caller ID is not shown 356  
can receive but not send  
T
TCP/IP menu 177  
telecommunication  
the scanner does not respond 365  
tips  
streaked horizontal lines appear  
on prints 347  
streaked vertical lines 348  
card stock 90  
labels, paper 91  
on using envelopes 90  
on using letterhead 91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
396  
toner fog or background shading  
appears on prints 349  
toner rubs off 350  
using Hibernate mode 244  
using recycled paper 241  
using shortcuts  
toner specks appear on prints 350  
transparency print quality is  
poor 351  
uneven print density 351  
white streaks on a page 351  
troubleshooting, printer options  
internal option is not  
sending fax 144  
using the address book 123  
sending fax 145  
using the touchscreen buttons 19  
Utilities menu 233  
V
detected 322  
verify print jobs 104  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 104  
internal print server 322  
Internal Solutions Port 323  
tray problems 323  
USB/parallel interface card 324  
troubleshooting, printing  
printing slows down 330  
troubleshooting, scan  
cannot scan from a computer 362  
partial document or photo  
scan job was not successful 363  
scanner unit does not  
printing from Windows 104  
vertical voids appear 351  
viewing  
reports 269  
viewing a fax log 147  
virtual display  
checking, using Embedded Web  
voice mail  
setting up 129  
Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP)  
fax setup 134  
voids appear 351  
VoIP adapter 134  
volatile memory 247  
erasing 247  
volatility  
statement of 247  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 364  
U
understanding the home screen  
buttons and icons 17  
uneven print density 351  
Unformatted flash detected  
W
Universal Paper Size  
setting 65  
Weblink server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 319  
wiping the printer hard disk 248  
Wireless menu 179  
wireless network  
Universal Setup menu 172  
unlinking trays 87, 89  
Unsupported camera mode, unplug  
camera and change mode 318  
Unsupported option in slot [x]  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
updating options in printer  
driver 55  
configuration information 58  
wireless network setup  
using the Embedded Web  
wireless setup wizard  
using 59  
USB port 52  
X
USB port [x] disabled [56] 319  
USB/parallel interface card  
troubleshooting 324  
using a shortcut number  
scanning to an FTP address 154  
using Forms and Favorites 100  
XPS menu 234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

KWC Indoor Furnishings K13H142000 User Manual
Lenovo Mouse 31043789 User Manual
LOREX Technology Computer Monitor SG19LD800 User Manual
Magnadyne Stereo Receiver M9900 User Manual
Magnasonic Projector Accessories MDVP455 User Manual
Makita Cordless Drill 60761 User Manual
Maverick Ventures Thermostat ET 68 User Manual
Maytag Washer MAV 31 User Manual
Meco Gas Grill 67A4T09K21 User Manual
Memorex MP3 Player MPD8860 User Manual